1 . $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.xfpt,v 1.69 2009/11/16 19:15:36 nm4 Exp $
3 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
5 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
6 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
7 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
9 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
10 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
11 . unwanted vertical space.
12 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
19 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
25 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
26 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
28 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
33 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
34 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
35 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
41 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
45 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
46 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
47 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
48 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
50 .set previousversion "4.69"
53 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
54 .set I " "
57 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
58 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
59 . provided in the xfpt library.
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
67 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
70 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
72 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
73 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
74 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
84 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
85 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
89 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
90 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
91 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
94 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
97 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
98 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
99 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
103 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
107 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
115 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
116 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
117 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
118 . --- ID that ties them together.
121 &<indexterm role="concept">&
122 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
130 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
131 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
139 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
143 &<indexterm role="option">&
144 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
152 &<indexterm role="variable">&
153 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
161 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
173 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
174 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
175 <date>5 November 2009</date>
176 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
177 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
178 <revhistory><revision>
179 <revnumber>4.71</revnumber>
180 <date>5 November 2009</date>
181 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
182 </revision></revhistory>
183 <copyright><year>2009</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
189 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
190 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
191 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
194 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
197 <indexterm role="variable">
198 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
199 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
201 <indexterm role="concept">
202 <primary>address</primary>
203 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
204 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
206 <indexterm role="concept">
207 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
208 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>CR character</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CRL</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>delivery</primary>
224 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
225 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
227 <indexterm role="concept">
228 <primary>dialup</primary>
229 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>exiscan</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>failover</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>fallover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>filter</primary>
245 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
246 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
248 <indexterm role="concept">
249 <primary>ident</primary>
250 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>LF character</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>maximum</primary>
258 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>monitor</primary>
262 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
266 <see>entry for xxx</see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>NUL</primary>
270 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>passwd file</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>process id</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>RBL</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>redirection</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>return path</primary>
290 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>scanning</primary>
294 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>SSL</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>string</primary>
302 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
303 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
305 <indexterm role="concept">
306 <primary>top bit</primary>
307 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>variables</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
321 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
322 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
323 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
324 . chapter "Introduction"
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
327 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
328 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
329 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
330 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
332 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
333 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
334 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
335 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
336 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
337 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
338 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
340 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
341 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
342 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
344 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
345 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
346 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
348 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
349 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
350 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
351 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
352 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
354 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
355 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
356 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
357 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
358 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
360 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
361 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
362 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
363 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
367 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
368 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
370 .cindex "documentation"
371 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
372 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
373 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
374 capable of showing a change indicator.
377 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
378 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
379 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
380 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
381 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
382 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
383 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
386 .cindex "books about Exim"
387 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
388 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
389 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
390 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
392 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
393 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
394 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
395 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
397 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
398 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
399 Debian-specific features in the file
400 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
401 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
404 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
405 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
407 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
408 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
409 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
410 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
411 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
413 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
414 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
415 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
416 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
418 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
419 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
421 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
422 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
423 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
427 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
428 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
429 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
430 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
431 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
432 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
433 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
436 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
437 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
438 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
442 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
445 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
446 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
447 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
448 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
449 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
450 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
454 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
455 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
456 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
457 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
458 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
461 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
462 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
463 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
468 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
469 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
472 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
475 .row &'exim-future@exim.org'& "Discussion of long-term development"
478 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
479 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
480 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
481 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
482 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
485 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
487 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
490 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
491 .cindex "training courses"
492 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
493 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
494 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
495 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
497 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
498 .cindex "bug reports"
499 .cindex "reporting bugs"
500 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
501 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
502 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
503 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
507 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
509 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
510 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
512 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
516 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
518 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
519 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
520 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
522 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
523 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
524 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
525 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
528 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
530 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
531 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
532 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
534 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
535 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
536 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
537 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
538 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
539 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
542 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
543 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
545 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
546 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
547 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
549 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
550 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
551 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
552 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
554 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
557 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
559 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
560 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
563 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
565 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
566 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
567 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
568 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
569 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
570 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
571 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
573 .cindex "domainless addresses"
574 .cindex "address" "without domain"
575 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
576 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
577 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
578 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
581 .cindex "transport" "external"
582 .cindex "external transports"
583 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
584 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
585 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
586 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
587 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
588 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
590 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
591 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
592 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
595 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
596 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
597 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
598 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
599 a number of common scanners are provided.
603 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
604 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
605 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
606 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
607 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
608 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
611 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
612 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
613 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
614 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
615 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
616 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
617 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
618 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
619 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
620 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
621 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
622 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
624 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
625 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
626 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
627 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
631 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
632 .cindex "terminology definitions"
633 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
634 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
635 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
636 below) by a blank line.
638 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
639 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
640 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
641 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
642 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
643 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
644 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
645 rise to further bounce messages.
647 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
648 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
649 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
652 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
653 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
654 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
657 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
658 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
659 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
661 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
662 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
663 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
664 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
665 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
666 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
667 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
668 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
670 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
671 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
672 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
673 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
674 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
675 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
678 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
679 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
680 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
681 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
682 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
684 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
685 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
686 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
687 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
688 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
689 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
691 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
692 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
695 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
696 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
697 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
698 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
699 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
701 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
702 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
703 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
704 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
705 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
707 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
708 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
709 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
710 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
711 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
712 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
722 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
723 .cindex "incorporated code"
724 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
726 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
730 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
731 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
732 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
733 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
734 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
735 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
738 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
739 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
740 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
741 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
742 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
743 following statements:
746 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
748 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
749 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
750 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
752 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
753 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
754 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
755 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
756 restrictions applied to it).
759 .cindex "SPA authentication"
760 .cindex "Samba project"
761 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
762 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
763 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
764 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
768 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
769 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
770 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
771 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
772 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
773 conditions expressed therein.
776 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
778 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
779 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
783 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
784 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
786 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
787 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
788 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
791 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
792 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
793 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
794 details, please contact
796 Office of Technology Transfer
797 Carnegie Mellon University
799 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
800 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
801 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
804 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
807 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
808 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
810 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
811 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
812 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
813 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
814 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
815 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
816 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
821 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
824 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
825 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
826 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
827 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
830 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
831 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
835 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
836 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
837 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
838 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
839 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
840 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
841 software without specific, written prior permission.
843 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
844 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
845 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
846 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
847 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
848 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
853 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
854 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
855 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
865 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
866 "Receiving and delivering mail"
869 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
870 .cindex "design philosophy"
871 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
872 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
873 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
874 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
875 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
876 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
879 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
880 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
881 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
882 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
883 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
884 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
885 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
888 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
889 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
890 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
891 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
892 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
893 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
894 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
895 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
896 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
899 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
900 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
902 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
903 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
904 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
905 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
907 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
908 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
909 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
910 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
911 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
913 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
914 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
915 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
917 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
918 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
919 runs at the start of every delivery process.
924 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
925 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
926 .cindex "Sieve filter"
927 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
928 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
929 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
930 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
931 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
932 of filtering are available:
935 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
938 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
939 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
942 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
946 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
947 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
948 .cindex "format" "of message id"
949 .cindex "id of message"
954 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
955 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
956 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
957 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
958 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
959 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
960 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
961 not always case-sensitive.
963 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
964 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
965 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
966 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
967 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
968 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
972 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
973 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
974 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
975 way of representing the date and time of day).
977 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
978 received the message.
980 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
982 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
983 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
984 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
985 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
986 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
988 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
989 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
994 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
995 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
996 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
997 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
998 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1001 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1002 .cindex "receiving mail"
1003 .cindex "message" "reception"
1004 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1005 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1006 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1007 there are several possibilities:
1010 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1011 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1012 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1014 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1015 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1016 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1017 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1018 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1019 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1021 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1022 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1023 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1024 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1025 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1027 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1028 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1029 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1030 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1034 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1035 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1036 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1037 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1038 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1039 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1040 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1041 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1042 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1043 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1044 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1045 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1046 users to change sender addresses.
1048 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1049 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1050 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1051 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1052 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1053 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1054 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1056 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1057 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1058 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1059 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1060 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1061 message is received.
1067 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1068 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1069 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1070 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1071 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1072 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1073 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1074 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1076 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1077 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1078 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1079 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1080 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1081 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1082 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1083 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1084 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1085 affect file system performance.
1087 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1088 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1089 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1090 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1091 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1093 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1094 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1095 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1096 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1097 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1098 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1099 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1100 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1101 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1102 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1103 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1104 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1108 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1109 .cindex "message" "life of"
1110 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1111 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1112 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1113 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1114 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1115 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1116 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1118 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1119 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1120 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1121 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1122 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1125 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1126 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1127 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1128 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1129 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1131 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1132 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1133 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1134 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1135 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1136 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1137 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1138 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1139 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1140 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1143 .cindex "journal file"
1144 .cindex "file" "journal"
1145 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1146 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1147 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1148 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1149 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1150 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1151 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1152 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1154 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1155 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1156 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1157 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1158 deliveries caused by crashes.
1162 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1163 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1164 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1165 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1166 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1167 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1168 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1169 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1170 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1172 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1173 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1174 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1175 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1176 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1177 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1178 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1179 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1180 the driver's features in general.
1182 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1183 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1184 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1185 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1188 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1189 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1190 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1191 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1192 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1193 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1195 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1196 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1197 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1198 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1199 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1200 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1202 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1203 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1204 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1207 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1208 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1209 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1210 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1211 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1212 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1213 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1214 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1215 configured to fail the address.
1217 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1218 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1219 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1220 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1221 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1222 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1224 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1225 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1226 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1227 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1228 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1229 the address is bounced.
1233 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1234 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1235 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1236 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1237 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1238 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1239 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1240 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1242 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1243 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1244 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1245 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1246 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1247 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1248 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1249 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1254 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1255 .cindex "router" "running details"
1256 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1257 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1258 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1259 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1260 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1261 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1265 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1266 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1267 original address ceases,
1268 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1269 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1270 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1271 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1272 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1275 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1276 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1277 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1278 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1279 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1281 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1282 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1283 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1284 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1285 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1287 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1288 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1289 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1290 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1291 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1293 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1294 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1295 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1297 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1298 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1299 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1300 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1302 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1303 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1306 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1307 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1308 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1309 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1310 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1312 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1313 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1314 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1315 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1316 facility for this purpose.
1319 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1320 .cindex "case of local parts"
1321 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1322 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1323 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1324 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1325 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1326 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1327 routed addresses are shown.
1331 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1332 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1333 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1334 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1335 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1336 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1339 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1340 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1341 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1342 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1343 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1344 of any other conditions.
1346 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1347 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1348 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1350 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1351 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1352 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1353 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1355 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1356 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1357 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1358 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1359 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1361 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1362 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1364 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1365 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1367 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1368 of domains that it defines.
1370 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1371 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1372 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1373 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1374 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1375 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1376 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1377 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1378 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1379 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1381 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1382 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1384 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1385 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1386 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1387 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1388 remaining preconditions.
1390 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1391 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1392 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1393 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1394 could lead to confusion.
1396 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1397 set of addresses that it defines.
1399 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1400 specified files is tested.
1402 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1403 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1404 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1405 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1409 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1410 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1411 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1412 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1413 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1414 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1415 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1419 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1420 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1421 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1424 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1425 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1426 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1427 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1428 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1430 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1431 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1433 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1434 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1435 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1436 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1437 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1438 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1441 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1442 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1443 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1444 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1445 processed entirely independently of each other.
1447 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1448 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1449 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1450 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1451 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1452 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1453 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1454 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1455 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1457 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1458 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1459 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1460 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1461 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1462 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1463 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1464 addresses to the same domain.
1466 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1467 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1468 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1469 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1470 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1471 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1472 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1473 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1475 .cindex "queue runner"
1476 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1477 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1478 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1479 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1480 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1481 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1482 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1483 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1484 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1486 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1487 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1488 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1489 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1490 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1491 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1493 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1494 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1495 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1496 messages to other addresses.
1498 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1499 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1500 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1503 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1504 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1505 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1511 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1512 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1513 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1514 .cindex "queue runner"
1515 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1516 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1517 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1518 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1519 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1520 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1521 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1522 passed its retry time.
1523 You can run several queue runners at once.
1525 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1526 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1527 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1528 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1529 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1534 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1535 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1536 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1537 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1538 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1539 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1540 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1541 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1542 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1545 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1546 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1547 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1550 .cindex "hints database"
1551 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1552 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1553 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1554 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1560 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1561 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1562 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1563 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1564 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1565 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1566 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1567 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1568 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1569 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1570 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1572 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1573 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1574 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1577 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1578 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1579 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1580 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1581 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1582 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1583 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1588 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1590 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1591 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1592 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1593 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1594 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1595 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1602 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1604 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1605 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1607 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1608 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1609 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1610 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1613 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1614 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1616 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1617 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1618 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1619 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1623 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1624 following subdirectories are created:
1627 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1628 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1629 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1630 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1631 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1632 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1633 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1636 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1637 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1638 that may be useful to some sites.
1641 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1642 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1643 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1644 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1645 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1646 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1648 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1649 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1650 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1651 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1652 overridden if necessary.
1655 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1656 .cindex "PCRE library"
1657 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1658 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1659 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1660 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1661 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1662 headers are in an unusual location you will need to set the PCRE_LIBS
1663 and INCLUDE directives appropriately. If your operating system has no
1664 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1665 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1667 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1668 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1669 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1670 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1671 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1672 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1673 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1675 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1676 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1677 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1678 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1679 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1680 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1681 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1682 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1684 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1685 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1686 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1687 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1688 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1689 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1690 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1691 Berkeley DB library.
1693 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1694 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1698 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1699 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1701 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1702 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1703 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1704 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1705 file name is used unmodified.
1707 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1708 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1709 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1710 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1712 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1713 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1714 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1716 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1717 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1718 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1719 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1720 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1721 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1723 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1724 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1725 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1726 operates on a single file.
1730 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1731 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1732 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1733 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1734 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1738 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1739 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1741 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1742 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1743 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1744 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1745 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1746 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1748 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1749 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1750 in one of these lines:
1755 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1756 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1757 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1758 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1761 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1762 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1764 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1765 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1769 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1770 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1771 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1772 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1773 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1774 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1775 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1777 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1778 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1779 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1780 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1782 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1783 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1784 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1785 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1786 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1787 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1789 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1790 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1791 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1792 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1793 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1794 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1797 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1798 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1799 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1800 facilities, you need to set
1802 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1804 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1805 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1808 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1809 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1810 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1811 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1812 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1813 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1814 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1816 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1817 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1818 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1819 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1820 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1825 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1826 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1828 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1829 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1830 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1831 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1832 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1833 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1834 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1836 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1837 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1838 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1839 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1840 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1844 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1848 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1849 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1850 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1851 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1852 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1853 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1854 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1855 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1856 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1857 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1860 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1861 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1864 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1867 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1869 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1870 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1873 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1874 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1876 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1877 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1881 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1883 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1884 library and include files. For example:
1888 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1889 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1891 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1892 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1893 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1898 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1899 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1900 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1901 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1902 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1903 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1904 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1905 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1906 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1907 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1908 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1911 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1912 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1913 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1915 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control files is
1916 &"exim"&. For example, the line
1918 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1920 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1921 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1922 All other connections are denied. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1927 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1928 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1929 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1930 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1931 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1932 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1935 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1936 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1937 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1938 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1939 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1940 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1941 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1942 support has not been tested for some time.
1946 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1947 .cindex "build directory"
1948 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1949 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1950 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1951 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1952 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
1953 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
1954 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
1956 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
1957 building process fails if it is set.
1959 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
1960 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
1961 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
1962 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
1963 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
1964 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
1965 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
1966 directory, should this ever be necessary.
1968 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
1969 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
1970 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
1974 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
1975 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
1976 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
1977 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
1978 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
1979 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
1980 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
1984 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
1985 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
1986 given in addition to the short output.
1990 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
1991 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
1992 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
1993 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
1994 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
1995 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
1996 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
1999 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2000 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2002 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2003 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2004 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2005 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2007 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2008 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2009 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2010 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2011 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2012 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2013 and are often not needed.
2015 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2016 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2017 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2018 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2019 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2020 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2021 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2022 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2023 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2026 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2027 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2028 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2029 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2033 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2034 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2035 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2036 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2037 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2038 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2039 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2040 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2041 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2042 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2043 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2044 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2045 containing the lines
2050 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2051 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2053 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2054 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2055 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2058 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2059 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2060 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2061 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2062 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2063 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2064 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2065 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2066 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2067 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2073 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2074 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2075 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2076 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2077 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2078 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2079 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2080 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2083 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2084 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2085 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2089 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2090 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2092 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2093 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2094 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2095 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2096 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2097 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2100 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2101 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2103 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2104 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2107 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2108 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2110 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2111 definition of all three of these variables into your
2112 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2115 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2116 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2117 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2118 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2120 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2121 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2122 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2123 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2124 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2127 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2128 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2129 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2130 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2131 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2134 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2136 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2137 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2138 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2139 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2140 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2141 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2145 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2146 .cindex "building Eximon"
2147 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2148 where the files that are involved are
2150 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2151 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2152 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2153 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2154 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2155 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2157 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2158 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2159 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2160 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2161 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2162 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2163 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2167 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2168 .cindex "installing Exim"
2169 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2170 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2171 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2172 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2173 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2174 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2175 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2176 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2177 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2178 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2179 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2180 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2182 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2183 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2184 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2185 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2186 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2187 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2188 alternative files, no default is installed.
2190 .cindex "system aliases file"
2191 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2192 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2193 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2194 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2195 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2196 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2197 and outputs a comment to the user.
2199 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2200 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2201 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2202 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2203 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2205 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2206 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2207 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2208 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2209 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2212 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2213 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2216 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2218 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2219 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2220 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2221 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2222 but this usage is deprecated.
2225 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2226 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2227 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2228 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2229 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2230 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2233 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2234 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2235 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2236 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2237 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2238 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2239 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2241 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2242 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2243 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2246 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2248 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2249 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2250 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2251 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2254 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2256 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2257 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2260 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2261 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2263 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2267 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2269 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2271 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2272 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2273 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2275 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2280 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2281 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2282 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2283 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2284 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2287 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2288 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2289 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2293 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2294 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2295 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2296 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2297 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2303 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2304 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2305 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2306 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2307 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2311 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2312 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2313 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2314 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2315 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2318 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2320 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2322 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2324 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2325 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2326 user agent. For example:
2328 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2329 From: user@your.domain.example
2330 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2331 Subject: Testing Exim
2333 This is a test message.
2336 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2337 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2338 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2340 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2341 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2342 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2343 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2344 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2345 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2347 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2349 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2350 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2351 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2352 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2353 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2355 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2356 .cindex "lock files"
2357 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2358 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2359 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2360 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2361 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2362 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2363 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2364 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2365 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2366 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2367 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2368 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2370 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2371 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2372 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2373 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2374 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2377 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2378 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2379 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2380 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2384 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2385 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2386 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2387 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2388 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2389 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2390 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2391 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2392 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2393 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2394 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2395 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2396 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2398 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2399 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2400 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2401 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2402 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2403 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2406 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2407 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2408 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2409 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2411 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2412 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2413 favourite user agent.
2415 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2416 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2417 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2418 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2419 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2420 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2424 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2425 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2426 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2427 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2428 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2429 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2430 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2431 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2437 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2438 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2439 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2441 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2443 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2444 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2445 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2446 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2447 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2449 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2451 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2453 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2454 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2455 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2460 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2463 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2464 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2465 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2466 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2467 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2468 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2469 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2470 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2471 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2474 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2476 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2477 were present before any other options.
2478 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2480 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2481 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2482 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2485 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2486 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2487 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2491 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2492 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2493 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2496 .cindex "queue runner"
2497 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2498 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2499 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2501 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2502 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2503 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2504 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2505 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2506 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2507 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2508 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2511 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2512 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2513 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2514 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2515 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2516 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2519 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2520 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2521 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2522 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2523 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2524 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2526 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2527 .cindex "envelope sender"
2528 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2529 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2530 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2531 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2532 users to set envelope senders.
2534 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2535 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2536 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2537 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2538 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2540 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2541 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2542 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2543 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2544 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2545 that are available to trusted users.
2547 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2548 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2549 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2550 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2551 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2553 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2554 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2555 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2556 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2558 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2559 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2560 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2561 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2563 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2564 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2569 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2570 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2571 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2577 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2578 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2579 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2580 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2581 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2582 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2583 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2584 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2586 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2587 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2588 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2589 . creates a man page for the options.
2590 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2593 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2600 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2601 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2602 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2603 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2606 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2607 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2608 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2611 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2613 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2614 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2615 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2616 clean; it ignores this option.
2621 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2622 .cindex "queue runner"
2623 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2624 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2625 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2627 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2628 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2629 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2630 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2632 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2633 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2634 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2635 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2637 When a listening daemon
2638 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2639 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2640 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2641 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2642 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2643 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2646 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2647 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2648 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2652 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2653 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2654 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2655 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2656 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2657 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2658 because these are reread each time they are used.
2662 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2663 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2667 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2668 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2669 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2670 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2671 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2672 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2674 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2675 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2676 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2677 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2678 test data. A line history is supported.
2680 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2681 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2682 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2683 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2684 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2685 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2686 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2688 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2689 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2690 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2691 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2693 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2695 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2696 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2697 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2698 of a file. For example:
2700 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2702 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2703 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2704 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2705 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2706 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2707 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2708 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2711 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2713 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2714 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2715 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2716 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2717 system filters are recognized.
2719 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2721 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2722 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2723 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2724 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2725 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2726 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2727 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2728 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2731 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2732 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2733 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2735 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2737 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2738 variables that are used by the user filter.
2740 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2745 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2746 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2747 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2750 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2751 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2752 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2753 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2755 When testing a filter file,
2756 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2757 .cindex "envelope sender"
2758 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2759 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2760 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2761 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2762 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2765 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2767 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2768 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2769 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2772 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2774 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2775 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2776 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2777 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2778 actually being delivered.
2780 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2782 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2783 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2786 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2788 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2789 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2792 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2794 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2795 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2796 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2797 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2798 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2799 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2800 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2801 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2802 after a full stop. For example:
2804 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2805 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2807 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2808 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2809 conversion to the canonical form is
2810 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2812 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2813 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2814 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2815 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2816 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2820 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2821 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2822 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2825 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2826 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2827 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2829 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2830 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2831 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2832 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2833 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2834 session were authenticated.
2836 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2837 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2838 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2840 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2841 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2842 specialized SMTP test program such as
2843 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2845 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2847 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2848 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2849 updating the callout cache database.
2853 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2854 .cindex "building alias file"
2855 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2856 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2857 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2858 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2859 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2862 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2863 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2864 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2865 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2866 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2867 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2872 .cindex "local message reception"
2873 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2874 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2875 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2876 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2877 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2878 if no other conflicting option is present.
2880 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2881 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2882 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2883 suppressing this for special cases.
2885 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2886 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2888 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2889 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2890 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2893 .cindex "message" "format"
2894 .cindex "format" "message"
2895 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2896 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2897 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2898 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2899 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2901 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2902 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2904 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2905 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2906 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2907 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2908 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2910 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2911 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2912 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2913 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2914 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2918 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2919 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2920 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2921 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2922 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2923 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
2924 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
2926 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
2927 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
2928 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
2929 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
2930 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
2932 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
2933 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
2934 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
2935 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
2940 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
2941 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
2942 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
2943 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
2944 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
2945 arguments, for example:
2947 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
2949 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
2950 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
2951 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
2952 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
2953 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
2954 users, the output is as in this example:
2956 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
2958 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
2959 configuration file is output.
2960 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
2961 is the name of the file that was actually used.
2963 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2964 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2965 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
2966 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
2967 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
2968 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
2969 written directly into the spool directory.
2971 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
2973 exim -bP +local_domains
2975 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
2976 local part) and outputs what it finds.
2978 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
2979 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
2980 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
2981 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
2982 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
2983 that driver are output. For example:
2985 exim -bP transport local_delivery
2987 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
2988 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
2989 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
2990 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
2991 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
2995 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
2996 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
2997 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
2998 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
2999 The output format is one item per line.
3004 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3005 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3006 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3007 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3008 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3009 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3010 to allow any user to see the queue.
3012 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3014 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3015 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3018 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3019 .cindex "size" "of message"
3020 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3021 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3022 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3023 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3024 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3025 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3026 before the sender address.
3028 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3029 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3030 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3032 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3033 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3034 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3035 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3036 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3042 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3043 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3044 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3050 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3051 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3052 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3053 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3058 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3059 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3060 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3061 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3065 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3069 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3074 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3075 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3076 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3077 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3082 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3083 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3084 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3085 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3086 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3088 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3089 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3091 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3092 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3093 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3094 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3095 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3096 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3097 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3098 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3099 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3101 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3102 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3107 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3108 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3109 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3110 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3111 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3112 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3113 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3117 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3118 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3119 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3120 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3121 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3122 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3123 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3124 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3125 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3127 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3128 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3129 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3131 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3132 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3133 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3134 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3136 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3137 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3138 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3140 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3141 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3142 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3143 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3144 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3146 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3147 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3151 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3152 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3153 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3154 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3155 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3156 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3157 messages to the MTA.
3160 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3161 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3162 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3163 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3164 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3165 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3166 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3170 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3171 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3172 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3173 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3174 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3175 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3176 the listening daemon.
3180 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3181 .cindex "address" "testing"
3182 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3183 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3184 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3185 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3186 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3188 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3189 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3191 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3192 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3195 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3196 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3197 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3198 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3199 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3202 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3203 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3204 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3205 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3207 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3208 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3209 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3210 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3213 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3214 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3216 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3217 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3218 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3219 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3220 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3221 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3226 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3227 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3228 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3229 It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3230 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3231 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3233 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3234 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3235 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3236 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3237 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3238 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3239 dynamic testing facilities.
3243 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3244 .cindex "address" "verification"
3245 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3246 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3247 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3248 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3249 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3250 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3252 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3253 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3254 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3256 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3257 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3259 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3260 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3263 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3264 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3265 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3266 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3267 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3269 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3270 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3271 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3272 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3273 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3274 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3277 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3278 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3279 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3282 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3283 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3284 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3285 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3287 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3288 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3289 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3290 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3294 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3295 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3298 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3300 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3301 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3302 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3303 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3304 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3305 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3306 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3307 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3308 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3310 When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
3311 list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
3312 immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
3313 the caller. However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in
3314 &_Local/Makefile_&, root privilege is retained for &%-C%& only if the caller of
3317 That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
3318 option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
3319 However, if you are using a &"packaged"& version of Exim (source or binary),
3320 the packagers might have enabled it.
3322 Setting ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY locks out the possibility of testing a
3323 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
3324 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
3325 as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the delivery,
3326 the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception
3327 and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue,
3328 using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3330 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3331 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3332 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3333 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3334 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3335 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3336 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3338 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3339 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3340 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3343 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3344 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3345 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3346 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3347 specified by this option.
3349 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3351 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3352 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3353 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3354 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3355 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3356 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3358 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3359 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3360 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3366 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3367 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3370 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3372 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3374 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3376 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3377 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3378 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3379 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3380 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3381 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3382 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3385 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3386 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3387 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3388 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3389 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3390 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3391 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3394 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3395 &`auth `& authenticators
3396 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3397 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3398 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3399 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3400 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3401 &`filter `& filter handling
3402 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3403 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3404 &`ident `& ident lookup
3405 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3406 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3407 &`load `& system load checks
3408 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3409 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3410 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3411 &`memory `& memory handling
3412 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3413 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3414 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3415 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3416 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3417 &`retry `& retry handling
3418 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3419 &`route `& address routing
3420 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3422 &`transport `& transports
3423 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3424 &`verify `& address verification logic
3425 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3427 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3428 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3429 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3430 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3431 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3432 turn everything off.
3434 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3435 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3436 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3437 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3438 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3441 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3442 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3443 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3444 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3445 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3448 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3449 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3452 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3453 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3455 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3457 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3458 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3459 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3460 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3463 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3464 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3465 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3466 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3470 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3471 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3472 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3473 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3474 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3475 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3476 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3477 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3480 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3481 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3482 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3483 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3484 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3486 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3488 .cindex "sender" "name"
3489 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3490 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3491 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3492 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3493 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3494 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3496 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3498 .cindex "sender" "address"
3499 .cindex "address" "sender"
3500 .cindex "trusted users"
3501 .cindex "envelope sender"
3502 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3503 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3504 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3505 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3508 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3509 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3510 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3511 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3514 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3515 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3516 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3517 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3518 examples of shell commands:
3520 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3521 exim -f "" user@domain
3523 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3524 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3527 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3528 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3529 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3530 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3533 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3534 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3535 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3536 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3537 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3538 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3542 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3543 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3545 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3547 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3548 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3549 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3554 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3555 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3556 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3557 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3558 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3559 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3561 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3563 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3564 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3565 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3566 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3567 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3568 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3569 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3572 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3573 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3574 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3575 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3576 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3577 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3579 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3580 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3581 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3582 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3584 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3586 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3587 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3588 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3589 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3590 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3591 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3592 can be used only by an admin user.
3594 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3595 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3597 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3598 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3599 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3600 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3601 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3602 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3603 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3604 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3608 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3609 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3610 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3614 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3615 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3616 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3618 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3620 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3621 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3622 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3623 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3624 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3625 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3629 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3630 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3631 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3636 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3637 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3638 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3640 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3642 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3643 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3644 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3645 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3646 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3647 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3648 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3649 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3650 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3651 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3652 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3653 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3654 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3656 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3658 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3659 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3660 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3661 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3662 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3663 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3664 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3665 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3667 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3669 .cindex "freezing messages"
3670 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3671 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3672 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3673 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3674 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3675 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3678 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3680 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3681 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3682 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3683 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3684 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3685 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3686 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3687 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3690 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3692 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3693 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3694 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3695 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3696 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3698 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3700 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3701 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3702 .cindex "removing recipients"
3703 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3704 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3705 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3706 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3707 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3708 can be used only by an admin user.
3710 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3712 .cindex "removing messages"
3713 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3714 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3715 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3716 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3717 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3718 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3719 placed on the queue.
3721 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3723 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3724 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3725 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3726 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3727 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3728 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3729 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3730 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3731 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3733 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3735 .cindex "thawing messages"
3736 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3737 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3738 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3739 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3740 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3741 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3744 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3746 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3747 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3748 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3749 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3751 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3753 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3754 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2922 format"
3755 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3756 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3757 only by an admin user.
3759 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3761 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3762 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3763 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3764 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3765 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3767 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3769 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3770 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3771 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3772 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3776 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3777 treats it that way too.
3781 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3782 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3783 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3784 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3785 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3786 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3787 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3790 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3791 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3792 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3793 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3794 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3795 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3796 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3801 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3802 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3805 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3807 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3810 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3812 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3813 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3814 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3817 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3819 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3820 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3821 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3822 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3823 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3824 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3828 .cindex "background delivery"
3829 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3830 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3831 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3832 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3833 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3834 processes to finish.
3836 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3837 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3838 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3839 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3841 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3842 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3843 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3844 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3848 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3849 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3850 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3851 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3852 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3853 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3855 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3856 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3859 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3860 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3862 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3863 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3864 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3865 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3870 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3875 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3876 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3877 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3878 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3879 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3880 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3881 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3882 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3883 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3884 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
3889 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
3890 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
3891 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
3892 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
3893 configuration file is in effect.
3895 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3896 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
3897 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
3898 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
3899 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3900 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
3901 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
3902 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
3903 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
3908 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3909 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3910 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3913 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
3915 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3916 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3917 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3918 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3922 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3923 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
3924 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3925 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3926 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3930 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3931 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3932 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3933 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
3934 The return code is 1 for all errors.
3938 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3939 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3944 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3945 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3950 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3951 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
3952 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
3953 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
3954 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
3955 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
3958 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
3959 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
3961 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
3963 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
3964 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
3965 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3966 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
3967 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
3968 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3970 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
3971 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3973 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3975 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
3976 followed by a colon and the port number:
3978 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
3980 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
3981 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
3982 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
3983 whichever one is last.
3985 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
3987 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
3988 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
3989 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
3990 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
3991 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
3992 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
3994 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
3996 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
3997 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
3998 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
3999 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4000 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4001 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4003 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4005 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4006 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4007 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4008 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4009 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4010 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4011 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4012 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4014 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4016 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4017 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4018 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4019 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4020 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4022 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4024 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4025 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4026 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4027 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4028 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4029 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4030 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4031 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4032 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4035 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4037 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4038 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4039 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4040 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4041 uses the name it is given.
4043 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4045 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4046 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4047 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4048 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4049 used, when there is no default.
4053 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4054 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4055 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4056 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4060 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4061 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4062 whatever that means.
4064 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4066 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4067 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4068 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4069 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4070 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4071 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4072 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4074 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4076 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4077 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4078 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4079 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4080 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4082 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4084 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4085 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4086 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4087 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4088 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4089 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4093 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4095 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4097 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4098 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4099 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4100 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4101 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4102 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4103 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4104 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4108 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4109 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4110 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4111 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4116 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4117 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4118 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4119 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4122 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4124 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4126 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4128 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4129 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4130 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4131 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4132 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4136 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4137 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4138 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4139 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4140 and &%-S%& options).
4142 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4143 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4144 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4145 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4146 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4147 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4150 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4151 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4152 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4153 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4154 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4157 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4158 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4159 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4160 this to be repeated periodically.
4162 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4163 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4164 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4165 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4167 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4168 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4169 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4171 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4172 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4173 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4174 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4178 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4179 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4180 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4181 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4182 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4183 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4186 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4187 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4188 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4189 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4190 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4191 delivered down a single SMTP
4192 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4193 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4194 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4195 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4196 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4199 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4201 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4202 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4203 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4204 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4205 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4207 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4209 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4210 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4211 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4212 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4213 their retry times are tried.
4215 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4217 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4218 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4221 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4223 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4224 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4225 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4228 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4229 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4230 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4231 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4232 starting message id. For example:
4234 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4236 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4237 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4238 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4240 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4242 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4243 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4244 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4245 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4246 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4247 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4249 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4250 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4251 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4252 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4253 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4254 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4255 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4256 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4257 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4259 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4261 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4262 process every 30 minutes.
4264 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4265 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4267 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4269 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4272 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4274 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4276 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4278 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4279 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4280 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4281 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4282 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4283 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4284 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4286 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4287 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4288 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4289 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4290 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4291 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4293 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4294 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4296 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4298 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4299 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4300 applied to each queue run.
4302 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4303 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4304 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4305 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4306 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4307 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4308 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4309 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4310 address will be skipped.
4312 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4313 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4314 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4317 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4318 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4319 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4320 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4321 an arbitrary command instead.
4325 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4327 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4329 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4330 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4331 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4332 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4333 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4334 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4336 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4338 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4339 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4340 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4344 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4345 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4346 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4347 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4348 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4349 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4350 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4351 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4352 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4354 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4355 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4356 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4357 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4358 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4359 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4360 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4361 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4362 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4363 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4364 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4366 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4367 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4368 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4369 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4370 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4371 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4373 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4374 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4375 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4376 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4377 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4378 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4379 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4380 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4381 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4385 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4386 compatibility with Sendmail.
4388 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4389 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4390 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4391 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4392 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4393 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4394 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4395 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4400 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4401 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4402 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4403 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4404 set. Exim ignores this option.
4408 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4409 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4410 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4411 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4412 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4413 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4418 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4419 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4420 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4428 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4429 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4430 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4431 . creates a man page for the options.
4432 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4435 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4442 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4443 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4446 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4447 "The runtime configuration file"
4449 .cindex "run time configuration"
4450 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4451 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4452 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4453 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4454 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4455 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4456 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4457 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4460 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4461 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4462 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4463 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4464 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4465 actually alter the string.
4467 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4468 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4469 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4470 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4471 existing file in the list.
4474 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4475 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4476 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4477 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4478 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4479 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4480 specified at compile time by the EXIM_USER option, or by the user that is
4481 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4482 configuration file must not be world-writeable or group-writeable, unless its
4483 group is the one specified at compile time by the EXIM_GROUP option or by the
4484 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4486 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4487 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4488 easy way to run commands as root. If you make your mail administrators members
4489 of the Exim group, but do not trust them with root, make sure that the run time
4490 configuration is not group writeable.
4492 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4493 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4494 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4495 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4496 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4497 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4502 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4503 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4504 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4505 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4506 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the
4507 Exim user (or unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value
4508 from CONFIGURE_FILE). &%-C%& is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
4509 configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
4510 on a configuration file specified by &%-C%&.
4512 The privileged use of &%-C%& by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
4513 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. However,
4514 if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
4515 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
4516 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
4517 as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
4518 use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4519 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
4520 &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
4522 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4523 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4524 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4525 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4526 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4528 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4529 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4530 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4531 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4532 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4533 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4535 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4536 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4537 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4538 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4539 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4540 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4541 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4543 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4544 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4545 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4549 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4550 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4551 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4552 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4553 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4554 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4555 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4559 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4562 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4563 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4564 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4566 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4567 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4568 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4570 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4571 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4572 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4574 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4575 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4576 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4577 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4580 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4581 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4582 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4584 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4585 want to use this feature, you must set
4587 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4589 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4590 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4593 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4594 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4595 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4596 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4598 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4599 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4600 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4601 and does not introduce a comment.
4603 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4604 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4605 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4606 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4607 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4609 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4610 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4611 change settings as required.
4613 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4614 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4615 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4616 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4617 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4622 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4623 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4624 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4625 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4626 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4627 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4630 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4631 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4633 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4634 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4635 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4638 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4639 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4640 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4641 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4643 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4644 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4647 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4650 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4651 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4656 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4657 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4658 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4659 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4660 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4661 definition, and must be of the form
4663 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4665 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4666 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4667 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4668 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4669 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4671 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4672 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4673 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4675 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4676 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4677 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4678 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4679 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4680 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4681 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4684 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4685 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4687 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4688 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4689 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4690 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4691 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4692 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4695 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4696 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4697 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4702 MAC == updated value
4704 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4705 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4706 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4707 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4711 MAC == MAC and something added
4713 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4714 from a number of other files.
4716 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4717 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4718 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4719 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4720 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4725 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4726 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4727 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4728 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4730 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4731 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4733 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4735 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4737 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4738 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4739 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4742 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4743 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4744 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4745 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4746 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4747 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4748 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4750 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4751 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4752 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4756 message_size_limit = 50M
4758 message_size_limit = 100M
4761 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4762 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4763 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4764 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4766 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4767 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4768 in this line"& will always be true.
4770 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4771 to clarify complicated nestings.
4775 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4776 .cindex "common option syntax"
4777 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4778 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4779 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4780 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4781 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4782 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4783 space) and then the value. For example:
4785 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4787 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4788 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4789 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4790 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4791 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4792 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4793 word &"hide"&. For example:
4795 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4797 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4799 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4801 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4802 all instances of the same driver.
4804 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4805 that are found in option settings.
4808 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4809 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4810 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4811 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4812 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4813 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4814 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4815 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4816 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4817 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4818 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4819 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4824 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4829 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4834 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4835 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4836 .cindex "format" "integer"
4837 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4838 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4839 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4840 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4843 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4844 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4845 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4846 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4847 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4851 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4852 .cindex "integer format"
4853 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4854 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4855 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4856 Such options are always output in octal.
4859 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4860 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4861 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
4862 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
4863 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
4867 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
4868 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
4869 .cindex "format" "time interval"
4870 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4871 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4881 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4882 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4883 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
4887 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
4888 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
4889 .cindex "format" "string"
4890 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
4891 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
4892 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
4893 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
4894 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
4895 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
4896 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
4897 therefore equivalent:
4899 trusted_users = uucp:mail
4900 trusted_users = uucp:\
4901 # This comment line is ignored
4904 .cindex "string" "quoted"
4905 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
4906 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4907 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4908 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4911 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
4912 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
4913 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
4915 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
4916 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
4920 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4921 character, that character replaces the pair.
4923 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4924 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4925 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4926 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4927 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4928 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4931 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
4932 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
4933 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
4934 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4935 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
4936 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
4937 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
4938 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
4939 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
4940 within a quoted configuration string.
4943 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
4944 .cindex "user name" "format of"
4945 .cindex "format" "user name"
4946 .cindex "groups" "name format"
4947 .cindex "format" "group name"
4948 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4949 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4950 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4951 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
4954 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
4955 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
4956 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
4957 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
4958 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4959 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
4960 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
4961 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
4962 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
4963 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
4964 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
4966 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4967 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
4968 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
4969 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
4970 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4971 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
4974 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
4976 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
4978 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
4979 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
4980 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
4981 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
4983 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
4984 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
4985 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
4986 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
4987 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
4988 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
4989 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
4990 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
4992 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
4994 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
4995 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
4996 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
4998 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
4999 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5000 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5001 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5002 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5003 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5004 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5005 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5006 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5008 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5010 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5011 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5012 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5013 the value in quotes. For example:
5015 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5017 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5018 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5019 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5020 enclosing an empty list item.
5024 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5025 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5026 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5027 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5029 senders = user@domain :
5031 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5032 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5033 items, the second of which is empty:
5035 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5037 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5038 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5039 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5040 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5044 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5045 is at the end of the list.
5050 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5051 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5052 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5053 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5054 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5055 a sequence of lines like this:
5057 <&'instance name'&>:
5062 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5063 followed by three options settings:
5068 transport = local_delivery
5070 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5071 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5072 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5073 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5074 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5075 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5077 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5078 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5080 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5081 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5082 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5083 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5084 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5087 .cindex "generic options"
5088 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5089 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5090 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5091 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5092 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5093 .cindex "private options"
5094 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5095 they all have default values.
5097 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5098 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5099 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5101 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5102 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5103 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5104 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5105 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5106 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5107 configuration lines:
5112 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5113 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5114 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5115 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5121 command_timeout = 10s
5123 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5124 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5127 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5128 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5129 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5138 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5140 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5141 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5142 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5143 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5144 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5145 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5146 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5147 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5148 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5149 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5150 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5154 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5155 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5156 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5159 # primary_hostname =
5161 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5162 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5163 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5164 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5166 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5168 domainlist local_domains = @
5169 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5170 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5172 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5173 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5174 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5175 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5177 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5178 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5181 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5182 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5183 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5184 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5185 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5186 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5188 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5189 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5190 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5191 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5192 domain is permitted.
5194 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5195 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5196 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5197 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5198 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5199 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5201 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5202 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5203 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5205 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5207 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5208 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5210 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5211 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5212 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5213 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5214 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5215 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5216 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5217 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5218 contents of a message to be checked.
5220 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5222 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5223 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5225 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5226 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5227 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5228 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5230 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5232 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5233 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5234 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5236 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5237 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5238 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5239 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5240 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5241 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5242 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5244 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5246 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5247 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5249 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5250 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5251 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5252 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5253 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5254 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5255 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5256 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5257 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5258 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5259 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5260 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5261 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5262 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5263 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5264 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5266 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5269 # qualify_recipient =
5271 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5272 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5273 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5274 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5275 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5276 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5278 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5279 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5280 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5281 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5283 # allow_domain_literals
5285 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5286 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5287 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5288 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5289 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5290 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5292 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5296 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5297 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5298 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5299 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5300 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5301 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5302 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5303 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5305 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5306 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5311 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5312 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5313 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5314 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5315 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5316 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5319 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5320 1413 (hence their names):
5323 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5325 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5326 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5327 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5328 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5329 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5330 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5331 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5333 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5334 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5335 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5336 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5338 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5339 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5341 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5342 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5344 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5346 # percent_hack_domains =
5348 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5349 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5350 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5352 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5353 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5354 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5355 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5356 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5357 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5358 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5359 always bounce messages.
5361 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5362 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5364 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5365 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5366 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5367 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5368 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5372 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5373 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5374 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5375 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5376 It starts with the line
5380 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5381 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5382 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5384 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5385 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5386 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5387 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5388 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5389 result of the ACL processing.
5393 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5398 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5399 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5400 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5401 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5402 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5403 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5405 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5406 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5407 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5410 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5411 domains = +local_domains
5412 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5414 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5415 domains = !+local_domains
5416 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5418 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5419 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5420 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5421 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5422 in Internet mail addresses.
5424 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5425 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5426 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5427 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5428 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5429 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5430 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5431 policy of being as safe as possible.
5433 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5434 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5435 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5436 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5437 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5438 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5440 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5441 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5442 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5443 have to modify this rule.
5445 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5446 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5447 common convention of local parts constructed as
5448 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5449 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5450 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5451 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5452 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5453 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5455 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5456 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5457 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5458 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5459 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5460 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5461 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5463 accept local_parts = postmaster
5464 domains = +local_domains
5466 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5467 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5468 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5469 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5470 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5472 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5473 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5474 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5476 require verify = sender
5478 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5479 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5480 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5481 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5482 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5483 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5484 discusses the details of address verification.
5486 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5487 control = submission
5489 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5490 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5491 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5492 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5493 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5494 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5495 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5496 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5497 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5499 accept authenticated = *
5500 control = submission
5502 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5503 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5504 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5505 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5506 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5507 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5509 require message = relay not permitted
5510 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5512 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5513 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5515 require verify = recipient
5517 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5518 fails, the address is rejected.
5520 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5521 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5523 # dnslists = black.list.example
5525 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5526 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5527 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5528 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5530 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5531 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5532 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5535 # require verify = csa
5537 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5538 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5543 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5544 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5548 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5549 of this ACL are commented out:
5552 # message = This message contains a virus \
5555 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5556 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5557 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5558 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5560 # warn spam = nobody
5561 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5562 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5563 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5564 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5566 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5567 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5568 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5569 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5570 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5571 whatever the spam score.
5575 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5578 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5579 .cindex "default" "routers"
5580 .cindex "routers" "default"
5581 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5586 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5587 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5588 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5589 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5590 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5593 # driver = ipliteral
5594 # domains = !+local_domains
5595 # transport = remote_smtp
5597 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5598 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5599 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5600 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5601 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5605 domains = ! +local_domains
5606 transport = remote_smtp
5607 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5610 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5611 domains. This is specified by the line
5613 domains = ! +local_domains
5615 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5616 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5617 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5618 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5619 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5620 passed on to the following routers.
5622 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5623 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5624 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5625 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5626 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5628 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5629 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5630 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5631 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5632 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5633 the address fails and is bounced.
5635 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5636 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5637 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5638 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5639 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5640 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5641 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5648 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5650 file_transport = address_file
5651 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5653 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5654 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5655 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5656 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5657 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5660 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5661 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5662 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5663 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5668 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5669 # local_part_suffix_optional
5670 file = $home/.forward
5675 file_transport = address_file
5676 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5677 reply_transport = address_reply
5679 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5680 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5681 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5682 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5683 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5686 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5687 # local_part_suffix_optional
5689 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5690 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5691 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5692 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5693 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5694 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5695 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5697 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5698 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5699 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5700 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5702 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5703 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5704 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5705 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5706 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5707 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5708 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5710 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5711 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5712 There are two reasons for doing this:
5715 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5716 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5719 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5720 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5721 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5722 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5726 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5727 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5728 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5729 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5731 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5732 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5733 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5735 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5737 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5743 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5744 # local_part_suffix_optional
5745 transport = local_delivery
5747 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5748 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5749 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5750 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5751 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5754 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5755 .cindex "default" "transports"
5756 .cindex "transports" "default"
5757 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5758 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5759 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5763 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5768 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5769 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5773 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5780 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5781 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5782 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5783 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5784 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5785 show how this can be done.
5787 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5788 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5789 similarly-named options above.
5795 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5796 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5797 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5806 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5807 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5808 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5813 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5818 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5819 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5820 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5821 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5822 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5823 introduced by the line
5827 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5830 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5832 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5833 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5834 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5835 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5837 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5838 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5839 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5842 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5843 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5847 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5848 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5852 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5853 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5854 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5856 begin authenticators
5858 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5859 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5860 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5861 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
5862 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
5863 to support most MUA software.
5865 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
5868 # driver = plaintext
5869 # server_set_id = $auth2
5870 # server_prompts = :
5871 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5872 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5874 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
5877 # driver = plaintext
5878 # server_set_id = $auth1
5879 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
5880 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5881 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5884 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
5885 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
5886 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
5887 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
5888 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
5889 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
5890 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
5891 need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
5893 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
5894 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
5895 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
5896 expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
5899 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
5900 usercode and password are in different positions. &<<CHAPplaintext>>&
5904 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
5908 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5909 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5911 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
5913 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
5915 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5916 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5917 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5918 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5919 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
5920 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
5923 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5924 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
5925 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
5926 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
5927 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
5931 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5932 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
5933 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5934 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5936 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5938 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5939 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
5940 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5941 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5942 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5943 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
5946 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
5947 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
5948 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
5949 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
5950 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
5951 match anywhere in the subject string.
5953 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
5954 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5956 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5958 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
5961 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5963 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
5964 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
5968 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5969 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5971 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
5972 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
5973 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
5974 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
5975 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
5976 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
5979 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
5980 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
5981 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
5982 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
5983 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
5985 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
5986 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
5987 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
5988 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
5989 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5992 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
5993 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
5994 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
5995 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
5996 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
5997 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
5999 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6000 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6001 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6002 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6003 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6005 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6006 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6008 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6009 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6010 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6011 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6012 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6014 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6015 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6017 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6018 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6020 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6021 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6022 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6027 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6028 matches the list item.
6030 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6031 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6033 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6035 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6036 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6037 causes a second lookup to occur.
6039 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6040 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6041 lookup is permitted.
6044 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6045 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6046 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6047 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6050 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6051 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6052 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6054 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6055 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6056 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6057 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6060 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6061 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6062 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6067 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6068 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6069 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6074 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6075 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6076 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6077 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6080 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6081 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6082 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6083 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6084 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6085 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6086 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6087 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6088 be found in several places:
6090 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6091 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6092 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6094 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6095 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6096 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6097 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6099 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6100 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6101 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6102 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6103 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6104 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6105 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6107 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6108 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6109 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6110 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6111 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6112 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6113 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6115 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6116 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6117 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6119 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6120 .cindex "dmbnz lookup type"
6121 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6122 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6123 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6124 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6125 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6126 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6127 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6128 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6130 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6131 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6132 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6133 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6134 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6135 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6136 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6137 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6138 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6140 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6141 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6142 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6143 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6144 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6145 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6146 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6148 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6149 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6150 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6151 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6153 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6154 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6155 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6156 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6157 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6159 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6160 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6161 lookup types support only literal keys.
6163 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6164 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6165 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6167 .cindex "linear search"
6168 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6169 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6170 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6171 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6172 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6173 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6174 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6175 in the file is used.
6177 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6178 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6179 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6180 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6181 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6186 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6187 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6188 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6189 wildcarding of any kind.
6191 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6192 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6193 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6194 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6195 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6196 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6197 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6198 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6199 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6202 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6203 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6204 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6205 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6206 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6207 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6208 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6209 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6212 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6213 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6214 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6215 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6216 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6217 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6218 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6219 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6220 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6222 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6223 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6224 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6225 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6227 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6228 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6231 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6233 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6234 *fish data for anythingfish
6237 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6238 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6240 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6242 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6243 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6244 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6246 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6248 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6249 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6250 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6252 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6255 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6256 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6257 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6258 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6259 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6261 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6262 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6263 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6264 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6265 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6268 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6269 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6270 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6273 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6275 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6278 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6279 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6280 be followed by optional colons.
6282 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6283 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6284 lookup types support only literal keys.
6288 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6289 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6290 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6291 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6292 many of them are given in later sections.
6295 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6296 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6297 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6298 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6299 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6301 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6302 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6303 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6305 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6306 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6307 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6308 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6309 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6310 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6311 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6313 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6314 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6315 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6316 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6318 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6319 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6320 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6321 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6323 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6324 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6325 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6326 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6328 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6329 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6330 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6331 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6332 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6333 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6334 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6335 password value. For example:
6337 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6340 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6341 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6342 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6343 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6346 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6347 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6348 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6349 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6352 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6353 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6355 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6356 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6357 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6358 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6359 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6360 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6361 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6362 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6363 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6365 require condition = \
6366 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6368 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6369 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6370 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6371 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6376 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6377 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6378 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6379 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6380 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6381 options such as a list of local domains.
6383 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6384 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6385 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6386 or may give up altogether.
6390 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6391 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6392 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6393 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6394 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6395 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6396 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6397 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6399 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6400 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6401 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6403 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6404 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6405 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6407 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6408 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6409 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6410 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6411 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6412 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6413 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6414 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6415 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6416 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6418 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6420 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6421 looks up these keys, in this order:
6427 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6428 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6429 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6430 Exim move on to try the next key.
6434 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6435 .cindex "partial matching"
6436 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6437 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6438 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6439 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6440 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6441 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6442 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6443 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6444 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6445 a key in a DBM file is
6447 *.dates.fict.example
6449 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6450 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6451 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6454 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6455 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6456 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6458 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6459 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6460 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6461 partial matching keys
6462 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6463 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6464 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6466 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6467 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6468 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6469 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6470 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6471 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6474 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6475 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6476 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6477 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6478 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6479 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6481 2250.dates.fict.example
6482 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6483 *.dates.fict.example
6486 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6489 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6490 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6491 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6492 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6493 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6494 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6496 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6498 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6499 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6500 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6501 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6503 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6505 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6506 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6508 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6509 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6510 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6513 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6515 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6516 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6518 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6519 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6520 for &"*"& on its own.
6522 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6526 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6527 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6528 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6529 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6530 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6531 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6532 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6534 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6535 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6536 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6537 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6538 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6543 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6544 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6545 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6546 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6547 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6548 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6549 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6551 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6552 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6553 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6554 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6555 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6556 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6558 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6559 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6565 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6566 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6567 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6568 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6569 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6570 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6574 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6575 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6577 [name="$local_part"]
6579 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6580 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6581 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6582 of the following form is provided:
6584 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6586 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6588 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6590 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6591 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6592 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6597 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6598 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6599 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6600 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6601 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6602 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6603 an expansion string could contain:
6605 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6607 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6608 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6609 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6610 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6612 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6613 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6614 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6615 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6616 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6618 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6620 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6621 altered and nothing is added.
6623 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6624 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6625 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6626 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6627 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6629 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6630 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6631 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6632 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6633 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6634 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6636 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6638 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6639 white space is ignored.
6641 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6642 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6643 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6644 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6645 the pseudo-type MXH:
6647 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6649 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6652 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6653 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6654 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6655 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6656 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6657 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6658 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6659 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6661 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6662 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6664 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6665 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6666 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6668 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6669 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6670 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6671 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6672 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6675 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6676 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6677 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6678 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6679 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6680 result of a successful lookup such as:
6682 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6684 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6685 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6686 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6689 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6690 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6691 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6692 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6693 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6695 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6696 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6697 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6699 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6700 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6701 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6702 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6704 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6705 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6706 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6708 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6709 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6710 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6711 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6712 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6713 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6714 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6715 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6716 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6717 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6719 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6720 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6722 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6723 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6728 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6729 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6730 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6731 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6732 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6733 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6734 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6735 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6736 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6737 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6738 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6739 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6741 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6742 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6743 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6744 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6745 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6747 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6748 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6750 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6751 the way they handle the results of a query:
6754 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6757 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6758 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6760 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6761 from all of them are returned.
6765 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6766 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6767 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6768 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6771 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6772 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6773 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6774 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6776 data = ${lookup ldap \
6777 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6778 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6780 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6781 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6782 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6783 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6786 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6787 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6788 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6789 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6790 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6791 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6793 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6794 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6802 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6803 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6807 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6809 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6813 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6815 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6817 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6819 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6820 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6821 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6825 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6826 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6827 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6829 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6833 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6835 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6837 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6839 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6840 authentication below.
6843 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
6844 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
6845 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6846 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6847 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6850 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6852 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6853 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6854 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
6855 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6856 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6857 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6858 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6859 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6860 failures, and timeouts.
6862 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6863 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6864 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6865 doubled. For example
6867 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6869 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6870 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6871 the local host) is used.
6873 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6874 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6875 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6876 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6879 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6880 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6881 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
6882 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6884 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6886 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6887 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6889 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6891 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
6892 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6893 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6894 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6895 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
6896 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6897 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6900 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
6901 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6902 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
6905 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
6908 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
6912 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6913 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
6917 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
6918 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
6919 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6920 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6921 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
6922 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6923 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
6924 them. The following names are recognized:
6926 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
6927 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
6928 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
6929 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
6930 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
6931 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
6932 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
6934 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
6935 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
6936 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
6937 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
6939 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
6940 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6941 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6942 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6943 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6944 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6945 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6946 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
6947 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6949 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6950 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6953 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6954 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
6957 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6958 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6961 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
6962 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
6963 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
6964 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
6966 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
6967 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
6968 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
6970 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
6971 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
6972 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
6973 quoting has two advantages:
6976 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
6977 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
6979 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
6982 For example, a setting such as
6984 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
6986 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
6988 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
6989 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
6990 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
6991 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
6995 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
6996 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7001 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7002 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7003 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7004 as a sequence of values, for example
7006 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7008 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7009 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7010 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7011 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7012 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7015 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7016 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7017 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7019 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7020 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7021 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7022 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7023 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7024 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7025 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7027 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7028 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7029 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7031 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7034 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7037 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7038 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7040 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7041 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7043 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7044 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7045 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7046 results of LDAP lookups.
7051 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7052 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7053 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7054 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7055 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7056 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7057 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7058 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7060 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7062 might return the string
7064 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7065 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7067 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7069 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7075 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7076 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7077 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7081 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7082 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7083 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7084 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7085 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7086 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7087 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7088 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7089 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7090 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7091 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7092 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7095 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7098 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7099 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7101 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7106 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7108 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7109 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7110 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7114 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7115 with a newline between the data for each row.
7118 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7119 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7120 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7121 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7122 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7123 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7124 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7125 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7126 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7127 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7128 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7129 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7131 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7132 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7133 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7134 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7135 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7136 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7138 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7140 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7141 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7142 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7144 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7145 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7147 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7148 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7149 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7150 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7151 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7152 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7154 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7155 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7156 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7157 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7158 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7159 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7160 characters are not special.
7162 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7163 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7164 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7165 done by starting the query with
7167 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7169 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7171 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7172 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7173 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7176 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7178 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7179 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7180 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7182 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7183 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7184 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7187 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7191 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7193 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7195 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7196 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7197 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7199 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7203 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7204 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7205 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7206 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7207 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7209 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7210 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7212 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7213 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7215 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7218 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7219 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7221 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7222 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7223 is zero because no rows are affected.
7226 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7227 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7228 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7229 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7230 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7233 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7235 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7236 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7237 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7239 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7240 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7243 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7244 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7245 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7246 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7247 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7248 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7249 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7250 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7251 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7253 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7254 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7256 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7258 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7259 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7261 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7262 quote, which it doubles.
7264 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7265 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7266 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7267 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7268 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7269 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7275 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7276 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7278 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7279 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7280 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7281 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7282 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7283 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7284 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7285 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7286 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7288 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7289 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7290 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7291 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7295 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7296 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7297 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7298 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7299 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7300 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7301 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7302 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7305 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7306 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7307 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7309 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7310 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7311 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7312 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7313 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7315 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7316 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7318 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7319 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7320 senders based on the receiving domain.
7325 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7326 .cindex "list" "negation"
7327 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7328 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7329 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7330 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7331 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7332 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7334 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7335 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7336 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7337 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7338 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7340 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7342 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7343 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7344 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7346 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7348 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7349 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7350 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7352 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7353 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7358 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7359 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7360 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7361 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7362 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7363 file names are not allowed,
7364 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7365 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7369 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7370 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7372 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7373 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7374 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7376 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7380 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7381 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7382 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7383 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7385 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7386 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7388 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7390 and the file contains the lines
7395 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7396 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7400 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7401 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7402 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7403 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7404 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7405 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7406 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7407 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7409 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7410 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7411 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7412 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7417 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7418 .cindex "named lists"
7419 .cindex "list" "named"
7420 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7421 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7422 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7423 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7424 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7425 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7426 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7428 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7430 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7431 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7432 configured with the line
7434 domains = +local_domains
7436 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7437 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7441 domains = ! +local_domains
7442 transport = remote_smtp
7445 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7446 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7447 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7448 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7450 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7451 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7453 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7455 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7456 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7457 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7459 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7460 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7461 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7463 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7464 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7466 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7467 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7468 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7470 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7472 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7473 referenced lists if you can.
7475 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7476 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7477 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7479 domains = +local_domains
7481 on several of your routers
7482 or in several ACL statements,
7483 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7484 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7485 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7486 the same each time they are referenced.
7488 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7489 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7490 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7491 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7495 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7496 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7497 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7498 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7499 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7502 ALIST = host1 : host2
7503 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7505 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7507 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7509 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7512 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7513 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7515 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7517 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7521 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7522 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7523 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7524 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7525 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7526 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7527 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7528 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7529 message. For example:
7531 domainlist special_domains = \
7532 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7534 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7535 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7536 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7537 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7538 same list each time.
7540 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7541 cache the result anyway. For example:
7543 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7545 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7546 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7550 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7551 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7552 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7553 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7554 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7557 .cindex "primary host name"
7558 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7559 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7560 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7561 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7562 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7563 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7564 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7565 differ only in their names.
7567 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7568 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7569 .cindex "domain literal"
7570 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7571 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7572 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7573 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7574 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7575 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7578 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7579 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7580 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7581 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7582 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7583 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7584 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7585 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7586 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7587 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7588 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7590 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7591 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7592 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7593 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7594 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7596 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7597 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7598 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7599 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7600 on a router). For example:
7602 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7604 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7605 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7607 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7608 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7609 contain negative items.
7611 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7612 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7613 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7615 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7616 an.other.domain : ...
7618 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7619 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7621 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7622 an.other.domain ? ...
7625 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7626 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7627 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7628 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7629 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7630 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7631 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7632 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7633 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7637 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7638 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7639 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7640 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7641 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7642 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7643 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7644 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7645 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7647 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7648 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7649 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7650 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7651 expression by expansion, of course).
7653 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7654 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7655 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7656 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7657 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7658 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7660 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7662 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7663 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7664 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7665 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7666 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7667 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7668 other statements in the same ACL.
7671 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7672 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7674 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7676 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7677 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7680 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7681 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7682 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7683 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7684 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7685 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7688 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7689 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7690 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7691 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7693 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7694 where domain = '$domain';
7696 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7697 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7698 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7699 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7700 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7702 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7703 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7704 between the pattern and the domain.
7707 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7709 domainlist funny_domains = \
7712 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7713 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7714 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7715 nis;domains.byname : \
7716 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7718 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7719 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7720 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7721 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7722 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7727 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7728 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7729 .cindex "list" "host list"
7730 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7731 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7732 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7733 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7734 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7735 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7736 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7739 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7740 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7741 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7742 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7743 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7744 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7747 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7748 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7749 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7753 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7754 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7755 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7756 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7757 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7758 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7759 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7762 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7763 inspecting its IP address:
7766 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7767 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7768 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7769 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7770 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7771 with the IP address of the subject host.
7773 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7774 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7775 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7776 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7777 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7780 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7781 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7782 domain name, as just described.
7785 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7786 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7787 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7788 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7789 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7790 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7791 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7792 that can never match a client host.
7795 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7796 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7797 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7798 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7800 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7804 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7805 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7806 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7807 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7808 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7809 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7810 significant end of the address.
7812 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7813 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7814 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7815 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7819 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7820 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7823 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7825 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7826 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7828 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7829 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7832 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7834 could make use of a file containing
7839 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7840 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7841 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7843 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7846 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
7852 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
7853 "SECThoslispatsikey"
7854 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
7855 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7856 address, the pattern takes this form:
7858 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7862 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7864 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7865 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7866 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7867 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
7868 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7869 returned by the lookup is not used.
7871 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
7872 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
7873 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7874 patterns of this form:
7876 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7880 net24-dbm;/networks.db
7882 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
7883 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7884 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7885 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7886 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
7888 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
7889 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
7890 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
7891 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
7892 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
7893 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
7894 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
7895 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
7896 addresses are always used.
7898 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
7899 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
7900 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
7903 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
7904 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
7905 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7906 case the IP address is used on its own.
7910 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
7911 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
7912 .cindex "unknown host name"
7913 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
7914 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7915 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7916 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7917 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
7920 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
7921 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
7922 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7923 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7924 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7925 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7926 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7928 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7929 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7931 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7932 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
7933 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7934 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
7935 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
7936 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
7937 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
7938 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
7939 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
7941 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7942 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7944 .cindex "host" "alias for"
7945 .cindex "alias for host"
7946 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7947 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7950 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7951 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
7952 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
7953 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7954 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7957 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
7958 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
7959 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7960 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
7961 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
7962 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
7963 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
7968 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
7969 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
7970 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
7971 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
7972 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
7974 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
7976 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
7977 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
7978 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
7985 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
7986 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
7987 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
7988 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
7989 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
7990 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
7992 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
7993 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
7995 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
7996 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
7997 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
7998 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
7999 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8000 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8003 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8004 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8006 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8008 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8009 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8012 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8013 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8016 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8019 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8020 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8021 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8024 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8025 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8029 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8031 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8032 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8033 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8034 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8035 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8036 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8037 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8038 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8039 host lists such as whitelists.
8043 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8044 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8045 .cindex "unknown host name"
8046 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8047 If a pattern is of the form
8049 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8053 dbm;/host/accept/list
8055 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8056 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8059 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8060 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8061 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8062 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8063 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8064 lookup, both using the same file.
8068 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8069 If a pattern is of the form
8071 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8073 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8074 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8075 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8077 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8078 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8080 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8081 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8082 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8085 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8086 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8087 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8089 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8090 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8091 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8092 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8093 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8094 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8098 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8100 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8101 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8102 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8105 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8107 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8108 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8109 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8110 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8111 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8112 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8114 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8115 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8117 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8118 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8120 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8121 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8127 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8128 .cindex "list" "address list"
8129 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8130 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8131 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8132 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8133 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8134 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8135 using this option setting:
8139 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8140 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8141 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8142 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8144 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8147 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8149 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8150 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8151 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8152 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8153 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8154 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8155 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8157 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8158 *@+hostile_domains:\
8159 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8160 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8162 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8163 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8164 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8165 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8166 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8168 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8169 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8170 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8171 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8172 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8174 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8177 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8178 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8182 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8183 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8184 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8185 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8186 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8187 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8188 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8190 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8191 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8193 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8194 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8197 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8198 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8199 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8202 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8203 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8204 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8206 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8207 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8208 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8209 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8211 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8212 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8214 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8215 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8216 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8217 default. For example, with this lookup:
8219 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8221 the file could contains lines like this:
8223 user1@domain1.example
8226 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8229 nimrod@jaeger.example
8233 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8234 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8236 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8238 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8239 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8241 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8242 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8243 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8247 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8248 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8253 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8254 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8255 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8256 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8257 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8258 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8259 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8260 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8261 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8263 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8264 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8265 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8266 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8267 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8270 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8272 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8274 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8276 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8278 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8279 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8280 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8281 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8282 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8283 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8285 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8288 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8291 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8292 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8293 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8294 might have entries like
8296 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8297 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8300 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8301 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8302 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8303 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8305 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8306 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8307 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8310 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8311 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8312 can only return a single list of local parts.
8315 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8316 in these two examples:
8319 senders = *@+my_list
8321 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8322 example it is a named domain list.
8327 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8328 .cindex "case of local parts"
8329 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8330 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8331 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8332 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8333 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8334 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8335 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8336 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8339 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8340 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8341 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8342 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8343 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8344 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8345 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8348 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8349 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8350 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8351 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8352 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8353 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8354 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8355 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8359 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8360 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8361 .cindex "local part" "list"
8362 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8363 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8364 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8365 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8366 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8367 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8368 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8369 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8371 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8372 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8373 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8374 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8375 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8376 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8377 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8379 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8384 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8385 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8387 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8388 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8389 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8390 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8392 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8393 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8394 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8395 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8396 escape character, as described in the following section.
8400 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8401 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8402 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8403 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8404 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8405 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8406 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8407 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8409 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8410 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8411 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8412 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8414 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8416 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8417 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8422 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8423 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8424 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8425 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8426 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8427 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8428 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8431 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8432 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8433 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8436 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8437 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8438 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8440 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8441 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8442 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8443 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8444 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8445 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8446 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8449 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8450 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8451 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8454 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8455 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8456 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8457 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8459 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8461 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8462 Exim message identifier. For example:
8464 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8466 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8467 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8470 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8471 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8472 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8473 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8474 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8475 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8476 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8477 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8478 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8479 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8480 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8481 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8487 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8488 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8489 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8490 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8491 white space is significant.
8494 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8495 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8496 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8501 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8502 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8503 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8504 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8505 given, the expansion fails.
8507 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8508 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8509 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8510 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8514 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8515 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8516 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8517 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8518 string easier to understand.
8520 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8521 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8522 expansion item below.
8524 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8525 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8527 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8528 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8532 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8533 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8534 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8536 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8537 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8538 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8539 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8540 must have the following type:
8542 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8544 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8545 function should return one of the following values:
8547 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8548 into the expanded string that is being built.
8550 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8551 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8553 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8554 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8556 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8558 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8559 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8560 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8562 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8563 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8564 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8565 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8566 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8567 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8568 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8571 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8574 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8575 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8576 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8577 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8578 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8579 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8580 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8581 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8582 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8584 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8585 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8586 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8589 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8590 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8592 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8593 appear, for example:
8595 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8597 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8598 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8601 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8602 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8603 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8604 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8605 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8606 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8607 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8608 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8609 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8610 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8611 <&'string3'&> as before.
8613 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8614 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8615 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8616 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8617 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8618 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8619 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8620 provided. For example:
8622 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8626 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8628 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8629 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8632 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8633 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8634 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8636 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8637 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8638 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8639 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8640 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8641 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8642 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8644 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8646 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8647 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8650 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8651 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8652 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8653 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8654 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8655 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8657 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8658 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8659 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8660 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8662 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8664 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8665 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8666 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8667 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8668 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8670 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8672 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8673 letters appear. For example:
8675 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8676 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8677 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8680 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8681 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8682 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8683 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8684 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8685 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8686 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8687 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8688 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8689 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8690 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8691 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8692 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8693 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8697 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8698 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8699 lines) may be present.
8701 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8702 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8705 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8706 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8707 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8710 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8711 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8712 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8713 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8714 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8715 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8716 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8717 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8720 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8721 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8722 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8723 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8724 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8725 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8728 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8729 command of the following form:
8731 headers charset "UTF-8"
8733 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8734 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8735 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8736 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8737 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8740 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8741 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8742 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8743 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8745 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8746 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8747 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8748 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8749 router or transport are not accessible.
8751 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8752 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8753 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8754 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8755 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8756 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8758 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8759 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8760 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8761 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8762 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8763 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8764 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8766 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8767 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8768 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8769 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8770 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8771 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8772 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8773 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8776 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8777 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8779 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8780 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8781 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8782 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8783 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8784 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8785 present. For example:
8787 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8789 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8792 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8794 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8795 an Exim configuration:
8797 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8799 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8802 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8803 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8804 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8806 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8807 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8808 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8809 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8810 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8811 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8814 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8815 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8816 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8817 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8818 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8819 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8821 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8823 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8824 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8825 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8826 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8827 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8829 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
8830 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8831 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8833 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8837 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8840 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8841 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
8842 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
8843 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8844 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
8845 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
8846 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
8849 ${length_<n>:<string>}
8851 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
8852 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
8853 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
8856 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
8857 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8858 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
8859 described in the next item.
8861 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
8862 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8863 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
8864 .cindex "file" "lookups"
8865 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
8866 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
8867 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
8868 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
8869 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
8871 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8872 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
8873 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8874 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8875 out by the system administrator.
8878 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8879 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
8880 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8881 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
8882 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8883 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8884 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8885 original lookup fails.
8887 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
8888 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
8889 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
8890 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
8891 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
8892 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
8893 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
8894 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
8896 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
8897 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
8898 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8899 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
8901 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
8902 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
8903 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8904 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8906 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8908 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8910 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8911 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8913 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8918 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8919 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
8921 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8922 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8923 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
8924 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
8925 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
8926 setting is not included in the output. For example:
8928 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
8930 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
8931 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
8932 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8934 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8935 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
8936 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
8937 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8938 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
8939 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
8940 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8942 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8944 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8945 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8946 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8947 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
8950 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8952 returns the string &"6/33"&.
8956 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
8957 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
8958 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
8959 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
8960 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
8961 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
8962 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
8963 name of the subroutine, is nine.
8965 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
8966 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
8967 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
8968 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
8969 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
8972 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
8973 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
8974 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
8976 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
8977 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8980 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
8981 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
8982 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
8983 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
8984 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
8985 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
8986 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
8987 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
8989 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
8990 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
8991 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
8992 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
8993 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
8994 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
8995 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
8996 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
8997 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
8998 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9000 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9001 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9002 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9003 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9005 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9006 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9007 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9008 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9009 is the expansion of the third argument.
9011 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9012 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9013 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9015 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9016 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9017 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9018 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9019 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9020 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9021 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9022 newlines are left in the string.
9023 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9024 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9025 the string expansion fails.
9027 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9028 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9032 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9033 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9034 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9035 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9036 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9037 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9038 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9041 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9042 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9044 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9045 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9046 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9047 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9048 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9051 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9053 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9054 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9055 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9056 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9057 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9058 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9060 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9062 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9063 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9064 turns them into spaces:
9066 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9068 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9069 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9070 addition, the following errors can occur:
9073 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9075 Failure to connect the socket;
9077 Failure to write the request string;
9079 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9082 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9083 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9084 errors occurs. For example:
9086 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9089 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9090 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9091 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9092 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9093 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9095 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9096 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9099 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9100 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9101 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9104 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9105 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9106 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9107 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9108 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9109 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9110 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9111 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9112 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9114 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9116 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9119 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9121 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9122 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9125 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9126 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9127 expansion item above.
9129 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9130 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9131 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9132 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9133 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9134 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9135 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9136 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9138 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9139 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9140 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9142 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9143 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9144 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9145 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9146 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9149 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9150 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9151 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9152 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9155 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9156 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9158 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9159 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9163 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9164 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9167 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9168 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9169 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9170 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9172 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9173 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9176 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9177 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9178 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9179 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9180 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9181 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9182 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9183 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9185 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9187 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9188 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9189 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9191 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9193 yields &"defabc"&, and
9195 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9197 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9198 the regular expression from string expansion.
9202 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9203 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9204 .cindex "substring extraction"
9205 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9206 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9207 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9208 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9209 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9211 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9213 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9214 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9217 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9218 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9219 length required. For example
9221 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9223 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9224 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9225 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9226 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9228 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9229 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9230 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9232 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9234 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9235 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9236 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9238 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9240 yields an empty string, but
9242 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9246 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9247 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9248 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9249 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9252 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9254 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9258 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9259 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9260 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9261 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9262 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9263 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9264 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9265 replacement list. For example
9267 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9269 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9270 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9271 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9277 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9278 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9279 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9280 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9281 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9282 following operations can be performed:
9285 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9286 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9287 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9288 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9289 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9290 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9293 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9294 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9295 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9296 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9297 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9298 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9299 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9300 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9301 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9303 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9304 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9305 character. For example:
9307 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9309 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9310 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9311 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9315 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9316 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9317 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9318 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9319 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9320 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9321 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9322 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9323 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9325 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9326 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9327 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9328 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9329 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9330 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9333 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9334 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9335 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9336 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9337 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9340 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9341 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9342 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9343 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9344 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9345 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9346 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9349 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9350 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9351 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9352 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9353 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9354 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9355 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9356 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9357 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9358 C programming language):
9360 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9361 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9362 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9363 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9366 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9368 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9369 space is permitted before or after operators.
9371 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9372 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9373 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9374 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9375 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9377 A number may be followed by &"K"& or &"M"& to multiply it by 1024 or 1024*1024,
9378 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9379 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"& or &"M"&). For example:
9382 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9383 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9384 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9385 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9386 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9387 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9388 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9389 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9390 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9391 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9392 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9395 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9397 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9400 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9403 {$recipients_count} \
9404 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9408 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9409 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9412 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9413 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9414 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9417 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9419 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9420 and then re-expands what it has found.
9423 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9425 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9426 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9427 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9428 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9429 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9430 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9431 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9432 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9433 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9435 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9436 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9437 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9438 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9439 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9440 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9441 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9444 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9445 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9446 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9447 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9448 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9449 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9451 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9453 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9454 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9458 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9459 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9460 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9461 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9462 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9463 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9466 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9467 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9468 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9469 .cindex "lower casing"
9470 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9471 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9472 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9477 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9478 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9479 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9480 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9481 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9482 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9484 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9486 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9487 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9488 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9491 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9492 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9493 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9494 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9495 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9499 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9500 .cindex "masked IP address"
9501 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9502 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9503 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9504 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9505 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9506 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9507 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9508 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9509 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9511 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9513 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9514 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9515 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9516 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9518 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9522 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9524 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9527 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9529 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9530 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9531 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9532 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9535 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9536 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9537 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9538 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9539 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9540 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9542 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9544 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9547 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9548 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9549 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9550 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9551 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9552 is an empty string or
9553 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9554 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9555 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9556 respectively For example,
9564 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9565 variable or a message header.
9567 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9568 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9569 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9570 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9571 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9572 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9573 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9576 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9577 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9578 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9579 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9580 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9582 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9588 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9589 yields an unchanged string.
9592 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9593 .cindex "random number"
9594 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9595 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9596 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9597 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9598 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9599 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9603 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9604 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9605 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9606 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9607 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9608 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9609 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9610 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9611 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9614 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9616 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9617 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9621 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9622 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9623 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9624 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9625 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9626 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9627 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9628 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9630 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9631 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9632 to use this operator as well.
9636 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9637 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9638 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9639 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9640 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9641 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9642 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9645 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9646 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9647 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9648 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9649 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9650 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9653 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9654 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9655 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9656 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9657 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9658 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9659 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9660 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9661 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9662 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9663 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9664 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9665 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9667 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9668 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9669 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9671 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9672 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9673 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9674 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9675 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9679 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9680 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9681 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9682 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9683 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9684 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9687 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9688 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9689 .cindex "substring extraction"
9690 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9691 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9692 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9693 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9695 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9697 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9698 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9700 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9701 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9702 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9703 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9706 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9707 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9708 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9709 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9710 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9711 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9714 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9715 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9716 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9717 .cindex "upper casing"
9718 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9719 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9720 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9728 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9729 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9730 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9731 while expanding strings:
9734 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9735 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9736 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9737 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9740 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9741 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9742 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9743 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9749 &`>= `& greater or equal
9751 &`<= `& less or equal
9755 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9757 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9758 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9759 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9760 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9761 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9765 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9766 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9767 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
9768 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
9769 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
9770 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
9771 false if zero. Leading whitespace is ignored.
9772 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
9774 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
9775 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
9778 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
9782 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9783 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9784 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9785 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9786 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9787 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9788 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9789 included in the binary.
9791 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
9792 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
9793 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
9794 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
9795 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
9796 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
9797 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
9798 string in LDAP form is:
9800 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9802 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9803 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9805 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9807 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9812 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
9813 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9814 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9815 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9816 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9817 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9821 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9822 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9823 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9824 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9825 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9826 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9829 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
9830 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
9831 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
9832 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
9833 whatever its length.
9836 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
9837 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
9838 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
9839 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9841 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
9842 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9843 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
9844 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9845 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
9846 support &[crypt16()]&.
9848 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
9849 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
9850 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
9851 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
9852 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
9854 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
9855 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
9856 Exim is seen as very low priority.
9858 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
9859 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
9860 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
9861 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
9862 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9864 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
9865 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
9866 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
9867 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9868 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
9869 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
9871 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9873 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
9874 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9876 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
9877 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9878 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
9879 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9880 exists in the message. For example,
9882 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9884 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
9885 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
9887 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9888 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9889 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9890 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9891 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
9892 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
9893 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9894 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
9895 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
9897 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
9898 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
9899 .cindex "file" "existence test"
9900 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
9901 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9902 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9903 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
9904 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9906 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
9907 .cindex "delivery" "first"
9908 .cindex "first delivery"
9909 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
9910 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
9911 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9912 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9915 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
9916 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
9917 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
9918 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
9919 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
9921 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
9922 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
9923 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
9924 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
9925 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
9927 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
9928 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
9929 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
9931 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
9932 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
9933 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
9935 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
9936 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
9937 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
9938 list separator is changed to a comma:
9940 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
9942 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
9943 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
9946 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9947 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9948 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9949 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9950 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
9951 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
9952 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9953 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
9954 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
9957 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9958 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9959 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9960 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9961 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
9962 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
9963 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9964 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
9965 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
9968 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9969 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9970 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9971 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
9972 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
9973 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
9974 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
9975 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
9976 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
9977 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
9978 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
9980 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
9981 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
9982 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
9983 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
9984 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
9986 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
9987 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
9988 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
9989 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
9991 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
9993 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
9995 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
9996 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
9997 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
9998 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
9999 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10000 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10001 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10002 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10003 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10004 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10005 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10006 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10007 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10011 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10012 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10013 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10014 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10015 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10016 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10017 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10018 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10019 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10022 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10023 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10024 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10025 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10026 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10027 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10028 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10029 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10030 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10034 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10035 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10036 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10037 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10038 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10039 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10040 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10041 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10042 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10043 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10044 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10047 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10049 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10050 backslashes is also required.
10052 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10053 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10054 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10055 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10056 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10057 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10059 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10060 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10061 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10062 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10063 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10064 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10065 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10066 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10068 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10069 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10070 See &*match_local_part*&.
10072 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10073 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10074 See &*match_local_part*&.
10076 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10077 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10078 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10079 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10080 address or an empty string. The second (after expansion) is a restricted host
10081 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10083 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10085 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10088 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10090 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10092 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10093 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10094 in a single test such as
10095 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10096 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10097 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10098 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10100 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10102 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10104 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10106 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10107 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10108 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10109 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10110 masks. For example:
10112 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10114 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10115 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10116 address mask, for example:
10118 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10120 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10121 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10123 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10127 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10129 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10130 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10131 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10132 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10133 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10134 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10135 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10136 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10139 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10141 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10142 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10143 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10144 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10146 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10148 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10149 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10150 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10151 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10154 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10155 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10156 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10157 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10159 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10160 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10161 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10162 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10163 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10164 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10165 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10166 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10167 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10168 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10169 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10173 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10174 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10176 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10177 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10178 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10179 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10180 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10181 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10182 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10184 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10185 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10186 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10187 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10188 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10190 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10192 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10194 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10196 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10197 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10198 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10199 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10200 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10201 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10202 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10203 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10206 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10207 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10209 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10210 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10211 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10212 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10213 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10214 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10216 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10217 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10218 building Exim. For example:
10220 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10222 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10223 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10224 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10225 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10227 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10228 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10229 configuration, you might have this:
10231 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10234 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10236 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10239 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10240 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10241 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10242 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10243 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10244 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10247 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10249 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10250 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10251 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10252 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10253 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10256 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10257 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10258 this library, you need to set
10260 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10262 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10263 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10265 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10267 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10268 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10269 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10271 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10272 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10273 the authentication is successful. For example:
10275 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10279 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10280 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10281 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10283 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10284 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10285 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10286 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10287 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10288 by a process that is not running as root.
10290 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10291 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10292 building Exim. For example:
10294 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10296 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10297 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10298 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10300 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10301 two are mandatory. For example:
10303 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10305 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10306 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10307 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10312 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10313 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10314 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10315 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10316 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10317 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10318 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10322 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10323 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10324 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10325 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10326 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10329 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10331 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10332 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10333 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10335 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10336 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10337 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10338 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10339 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10340 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10341 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10342 parsed but not evaluated.
10344 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10349 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10350 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10351 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10352 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10353 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10356 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10357 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10358 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10359 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10360 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10361 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10362 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10363 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10364 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10365 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10366 matching condition.
10368 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10369 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10370 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10371 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10372 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10373 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10374 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10375 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10376 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10377 during subsequent delivery.
10379 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10380 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10381 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10382 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10383 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10384 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10385 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10386 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10389 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10390 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10391 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10392 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10393 be preserved by coding like this:
10395 warn !verify = sender
10396 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10398 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10399 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10402 .vitem &$address_data$&
10403 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10404 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10405 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10406 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10407 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10408 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10411 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10412 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10413 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10414 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10415 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10416 from the child's routing.
10418 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10419 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10420 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10423 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10424 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10425 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10427 .vitem &$address_file$&
10428 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10429 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10430 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10431 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10432 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10434 /home/r2d2/savemail
10436 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10437 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10438 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10439 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10440 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10441 to the relevant file.
10443 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10444 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10445 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10446 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10448 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10449 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10450 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10451 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10453 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10454 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10455 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10456 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10457 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10458 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10459 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10460 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10461 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10462 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10463 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10464 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10465 command line option.
10470 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10471 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10472 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10473 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10474 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10475 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10476 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10477 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10478 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10479 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10480 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10482 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10483 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10484 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10485 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10486 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10489 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10490 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10491 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10492 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10493 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10494 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10495 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10496 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10497 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10498 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10499 an undefined mechanism.
10501 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10502 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10503 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10504 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10505 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10506 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10508 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10509 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10510 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10511 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10512 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10513 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10514 number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
10516 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10517 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10518 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10519 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10520 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10522 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10523 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10524 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10525 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10526 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10528 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10529 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10530 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10531 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10532 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10533 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10534 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10536 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10537 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10538 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10539 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10540 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10541 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10542 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10544 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10545 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10546 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10548 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10549 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10550 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10551 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10552 compilations of the same version of the program.
10554 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10555 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10556 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10557 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10558 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10560 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10561 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10562 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10563 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10564 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10566 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10567 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10568 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10570 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10571 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10572 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10573 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10574 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10575 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10576 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10577 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10578 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10581 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10582 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10583 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10584 case for &$domain$&.
10586 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10587 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10588 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10589 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10591 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10592 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10593 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10594 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10595 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10596 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10598 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10599 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10600 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10602 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10605 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10606 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10607 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10608 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10609 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10610 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10611 the &(smtp)& transport.
10614 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10615 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10616 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10617 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10620 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10621 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10622 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10623 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10624 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10625 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10628 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10629 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10630 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10631 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10635 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10636 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10637 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10638 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10639 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10640 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10641 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10644 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10645 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10646 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10649 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10650 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10651 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10653 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10654 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10655 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10657 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10658 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10659 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10661 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10662 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10663 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10664 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10665 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10667 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10668 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10669 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10670 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10671 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10675 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10676 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10677 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10678 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10679 by a setting on the transport itself.
10681 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10682 of the environment variable HOME.
10686 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10687 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10688 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10689 to local and remote transports.
10691 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10692 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10693 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10694 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10695 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10696 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10697 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10700 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10701 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10702 client is connected.
10705 .vitem &$host_address$&
10706 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10707 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10708 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10709 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10711 .vitem &$host_data$&
10712 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10713 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10714 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10715 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10717 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10718 message = $host_data
10720 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10721 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10722 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10723 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10724 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10725 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10726 variables is set to &"1"&.
10729 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10730 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10733 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10734 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10735 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10738 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10739 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10740 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10741 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10742 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10743 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10744 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10745 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10746 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10747 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10749 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10750 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10751 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10755 .vindex "&$inode$&"
10756 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
10757 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
10758 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
10759 a unique name for the file.
10761 .vitem &$interface_address$&
10762 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
10763 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
10765 .vitem &$interface_port$&
10766 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
10767 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
10771 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
10772 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
10773 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
10777 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
10778 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
10779 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
10782 .vitem &$load_average$&
10783 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
10784 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
10785 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
10786 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
10788 .vitem &$local_part$&
10789 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
10790 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
10791 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
10792 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
10793 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
10795 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10796 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
10797 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
10798 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
10801 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10802 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10803 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
10804 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
10805 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
10806 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
10808 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
10809 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
10810 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
10813 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
10814 local part of the recipient address.
10816 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10817 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
10818 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
10820 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
10823 "abc:xyz"@test.example
10824 abc\:xyz@test.example
10826 the value of &$local_part$& is
10830 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
10831 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
10834 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
10836 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
10837 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
10838 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
10840 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
10841 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
10842 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
10843 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
10844 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
10845 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
10846 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
10848 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
10849 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
10850 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
10851 variable expands to nothing.
10853 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
10854 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10855 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10856 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10857 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10859 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
10860 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10861 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10862 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10863 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10865 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
10866 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
10867 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
10868 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
10870 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
10871 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
10872 See &$local_user_uid$&.
10874 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
10875 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
10876 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
10877 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
10878 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
10879 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
10880 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
10881 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
10883 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
10884 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
10885 This contains the expanded value of the
10886 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
10889 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
10890 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
10891 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
10892 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
10893 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
10894 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
10896 .vitem &$log_space$&
10897 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
10898 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
10899 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
10900 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
10901 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
10902 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
10905 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
10906 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
10907 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
10908 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
10909 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
10910 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
10911 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
10914 .vitem &$malware_name$&
10915 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
10916 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10917 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
10918 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
10920 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
10921 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
10922 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
10923 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
10924 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
10925 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
10928 .vitem &$message_age$&
10929 .cindex "message" "age of"
10930 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
10931 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
10932 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
10935 .vitem &$message_body$&
10936 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10937 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10938 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10939 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
10940 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
10941 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
10942 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
10943 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
10944 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
10946 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
10947 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
10948 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
10949 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
10950 zeros are always converted into spaces.
10952 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
10953 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10954 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10955 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
10956 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
10957 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
10960 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
10961 .cindex "body of message" "size"
10962 .cindex "message body" "size"
10963 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
10964 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
10965 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
10966 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
10967 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
10969 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
10970 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
10971 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10972 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
10973 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
10974 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
10975 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
10976 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
10978 .vitem &$message_headers$&
10979 .vindex &$message_headers$&
10980 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
10981 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
10982 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
10983 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
10985 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
10986 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
10987 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
10988 contents of header lines is done.
10990 .vitem &$message_id$&
10991 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
10993 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
10994 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
10995 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
10996 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
10997 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
10998 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
10999 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11000 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11001 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11002 from the body is not counted. Here is an example of the use of this variable in
11005 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11007 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11009 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11010 message has not yet been received.
11012 .vitem &$message_size$&
11013 .cindex "size" "of message"
11014 .cindex "message" "size"
11015 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11016 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11017 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11018 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11019 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11020 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11021 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11022 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11023 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11026 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11027 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11028 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11029 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11032 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11033 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11034 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11035 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11037 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11038 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11039 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11041 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11042 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11043 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11044 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11045 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11046 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11047 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11048 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11049 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11050 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11052 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11053 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11054 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11056 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11057 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11058 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11059 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11060 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11061 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11062 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11063 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11064 the original address.
11066 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11067 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11068 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11069 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11070 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11072 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11073 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11074 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11076 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11077 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11078 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11079 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11080 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11081 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11082 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11083 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11084 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11086 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11087 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11088 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11089 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11090 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11091 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11092 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11093 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11096 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11097 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11098 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11099 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11101 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11102 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11103 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11104 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11107 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11109 This variable contains the current process id.
11111 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11112 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11113 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11114 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11115 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11116 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11117 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11118 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11119 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11120 variable"& error if encountered.
11122 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11123 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11124 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11125 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11126 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11127 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11128 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11131 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11132 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11133 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11134 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11136 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11137 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11138 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11139 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11141 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11142 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11143 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11144 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11146 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11147 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11148 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11150 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11151 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11152 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11153 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11155 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11156 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11157 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11158 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11159 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11161 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11162 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11163 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11164 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11165 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11166 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11168 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11169 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11170 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11171 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11172 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11174 .vitem &$received_count$&
11175 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11176 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11177 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11178 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11181 .vitem &$received_for$&
11182 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11183 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11184 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11185 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11186 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11188 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11189 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11190 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11191 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11192 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11193 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11194 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11197 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11198 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11199 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11200 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11201 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11204 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11205 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11206 &(smtp)& transport).
11208 .vitem &$received_port$&
11209 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11210 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11212 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11213 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11214 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11215 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11216 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11217 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11218 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11219 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11220 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11222 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11223 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11224 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11225 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11226 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11227 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11229 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11230 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11231 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11233 .vitem &$received_time$&
11234 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11235 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11236 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11238 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11239 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11240 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11241 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11242 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11244 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11245 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11247 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11248 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11249 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11250 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11252 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11253 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11254 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11255 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11258 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11259 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11262 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11265 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11266 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11270 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11273 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11276 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11277 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11279 .vitem &$recipients$&
11280 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11281 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11282 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11283 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11284 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11288 In a system filter file.
11290 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11291 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11292 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11293 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11295 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11299 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11300 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11301 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11302 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11303 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11304 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11307 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11308 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11309 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11310 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11313 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11314 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11315 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11316 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11317 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11318 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11319 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11321 .vitem &$return_path$&
11322 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11323 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11324 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11325 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11326 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11327 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11328 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11329 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11330 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11331 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11334 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11335 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11336 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11339 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11340 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11341 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11342 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11343 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11344 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11345 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11348 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11349 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11350 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11351 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11352 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11353 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11354 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11355 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11357 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11358 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11359 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11360 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11361 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11362 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11364 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11365 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11366 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11367 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11368 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11369 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11370 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11371 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11373 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11374 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11375 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11377 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11378 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11379 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11381 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11382 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11383 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11384 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11385 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11388 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11389 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11391 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11392 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11393 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11394 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11396 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11397 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11398 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11399 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11400 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11401 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11402 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11403 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11404 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11405 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11406 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11407 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11408 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11410 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11411 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11412 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11413 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11414 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11415 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11417 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11418 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11419 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11420 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11422 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11423 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11424 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11425 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11426 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11427 &$authenticated_id$&.
11429 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11430 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11431 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11432 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11433 other means, this variable is empty.
11435 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11436 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11437 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11438 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11439 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11440 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11441 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11443 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11444 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11445 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11446 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11448 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11449 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11450 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11453 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11454 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11455 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11456 following are true:
11459 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11461 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11462 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11463 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11465 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11466 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11467 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11469 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11470 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11471 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11473 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11474 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11475 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11476 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11478 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11480 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11481 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11485 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11486 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11487 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11488 number that was used on the remote host.
11490 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11491 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11492 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11493 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11494 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11497 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11498 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11499 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11500 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11502 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11503 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11504 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11505 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11506 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11507 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11508 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11509 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11510 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11511 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11512 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11515 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11516 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11517 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11518 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11519 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11521 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11522 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11523 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11524 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11525 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11527 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11528 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11529 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11530 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11531 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11532 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11533 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11535 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11536 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11537 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11538 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11539 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11541 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11542 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11543 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11544 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11545 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11546 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11548 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11549 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11550 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11551 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11552 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11557 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11558 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11559 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11560 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11562 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11563 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11564 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11565 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11566 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11567 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11568 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11570 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11571 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11572 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11573 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11574 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11575 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11576 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11577 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11578 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11579 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11580 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11582 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11583 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11584 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11585 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11586 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11587 message is junk mail.
11589 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11590 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11591 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11592 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11595 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11596 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11597 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11599 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11600 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11601 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11602 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11603 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11604 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11606 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11607 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11608 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11609 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11610 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11611 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11612 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11613 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11615 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11617 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11620 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11621 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11622 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11623 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11624 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11625 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11627 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11628 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11629 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11630 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11632 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11633 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11634 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11635 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11636 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11637 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11638 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11639 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11641 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11642 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11643 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11644 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11645 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11646 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11648 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11649 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11650 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11651 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11652 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11653 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11654 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11657 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11658 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11659 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11660 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11662 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11663 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11664 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11666 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11667 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11668 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11669 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11670 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11671 values for those that are behind (west).
11674 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11675 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11676 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11678 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11679 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11680 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11681 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11684 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11685 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11686 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11689 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11690 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11691 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11692 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11695 .vindex "&$value$&"
11696 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11697 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11698 &*reduce*& expansion.
11700 .vitem &$version_number$&
11701 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
11702 The version number of Exim.
11704 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11705 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11706 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11707 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11709 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11710 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11711 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11712 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11721 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
11722 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
11723 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
11724 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
11725 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
11726 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
11731 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
11734 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
11735 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
11736 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
11737 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
11738 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
11739 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
11740 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
11741 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
11742 a newly created Perl interpreter.
11744 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
11745 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
11746 should usually be something like
11748 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
11750 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
11751 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
11752 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
11753 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
11754 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
11755 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
11756 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
11757 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
11761 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
11762 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
11763 a startup when Exim is entered.
11765 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
11766 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
11769 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
11770 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
11773 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
11774 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
11775 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
11776 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
11780 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
11781 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
11783 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
11784 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
11785 with an error message of the form
11787 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
11789 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
11790 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
11791 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
11792 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
11793 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
11794 that was passed to &%die%&.
11797 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
11798 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
11799 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
11802 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
11804 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
11805 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
11806 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
11808 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
11809 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
11810 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
11811 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
11813 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
11814 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
11815 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
11816 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
11817 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
11818 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
11819 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
11822 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
11823 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
11824 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
11825 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
11826 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
11827 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
11828 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
11829 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
11830 avoided, but the output is lost.
11832 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
11833 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
11834 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
11835 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
11836 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
11837 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
11838 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
11840 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
11842 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
11843 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
11844 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
11845 as the first subroutine argument.
11849 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11850 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11852 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
11853 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
11854 "Starting the daemon"
11855 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
11856 .cindex "interface" "listening"
11857 .cindex "network interface"
11858 .cindex "interface" "network"
11859 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
11860 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
11861 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
11862 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
11863 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
11864 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
11865 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
11866 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
11867 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
11868 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
11869 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
11872 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
11873 and ports to listen on.
11875 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
11876 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
11877 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
11878 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
11879 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
11880 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
11881 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
11882 as an error situation.
11884 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
11885 for the outgoing connection.
11889 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
11890 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
11891 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
11892 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
11893 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
11895 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
11896 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
11897 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
11898 chapter describes how they operate.
11900 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
11901 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
11905 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
11906 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
11907 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
11911 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
11912 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
11914 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
11915 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
11918 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
11919 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
11920 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
11921 colons. For example:
11923 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
11926 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
11928 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
11929 in &%local_interfaces%&:
11932 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
11933 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
11935 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
11936 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
11939 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
11940 with a colon separator, for example:
11942 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
11943 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
11947 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
11948 default setting contains just one port:
11950 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
11952 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
11953 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
11954 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
11955 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
11956 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
11960 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
11961 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
11962 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
11963 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
11964 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
11965 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11967 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
11969 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
11971 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
11973 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
11977 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
11978 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
11979 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
11980 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
11981 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
11982 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
11985 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
11986 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
11987 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
11988 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
11989 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11990 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
11994 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
11997 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
11999 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12000 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12001 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12005 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12006 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12007 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12008 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12009 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12010 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12011 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12012 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12013 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12014 common use of this option is expected to be
12016 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12018 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12019 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12020 this way when a daemon is started.
12022 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12023 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12024 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12025 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12026 connections via the daemon.)
12031 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12032 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12033 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12034 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12035 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12036 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12037 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12038 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12040 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12042 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12043 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12044 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12045 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12046 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12047 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12049 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12051 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12052 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12053 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12054 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12055 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12057 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12058 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12059 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12060 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12061 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12062 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12063 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12064 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12065 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12066 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12067 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12068 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12070 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12071 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12072 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12073 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12074 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12078 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12079 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12081 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12082 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12084 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12085 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12086 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12087 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12089 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12091 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12093 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12095 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12096 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12098 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12099 IPv4 loopback address only:
12101 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12103 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12105 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12107 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12111 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12112 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12113 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12114 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12117 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12118 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12119 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12120 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12122 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12123 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12124 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12125 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12126 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12127 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12128 used for listening. Consider this example:
12130 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12132 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12134 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12136 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12137 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12140 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12141 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12142 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12143 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12144 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12145 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12146 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12147 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12151 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12152 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12153 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12154 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12155 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12156 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12162 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12165 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12166 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12167 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12168 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12171 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12172 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12174 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12175 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12176 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12178 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12179 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12180 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12181 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12185 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12186 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12187 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12188 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12189 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12190 listed in more than one group.
12192 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12194 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12195 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12196 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12197 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12198 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12199 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12200 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12201 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12202 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12206 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12208 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12209 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12210 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12211 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12212 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12213 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12218 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12220 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12221 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12222 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12223 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12224 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12225 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12226 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12227 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12228 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12229 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12230 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12235 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12237 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12238 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12239 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12240 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12241 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12242 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12243 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12244 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12245 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12246 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12247 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12248 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12253 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12255 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12256 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12257 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12258 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12263 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12265 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12266 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12267 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12268 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12269 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12270 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12271 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12272 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12277 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12279 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12280 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12285 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12287 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12288 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12293 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12295 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12296 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12297 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12298 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12299 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12300 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12301 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12306 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12308 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12309 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12310 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12311 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12312 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12313 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12314 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12315 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12316 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12317 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12318 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12319 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12320 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12321 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12322 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12323 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12325 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12326 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12327 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12328 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12329 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12334 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12336 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12337 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12338 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12339 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12340 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12341 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12342 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12343 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12344 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12345 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12346 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12347 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12348 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12349 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12350 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12351 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12352 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12353 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12354 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12356 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12357 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12358 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12359 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12360 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12361 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12362 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12363 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12364 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12365 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12366 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12367 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12368 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12369 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12370 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12371 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12372 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12373 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12378 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12380 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12382 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12384 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12385 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12386 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12391 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12393 .row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
12394 .row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
12395 .row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
12396 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12397 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12398 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12399 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12400 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12401 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12402 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12403 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12404 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12405 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12406 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12407 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12412 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12414 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12415 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12416 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12417 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12418 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12419 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12420 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12421 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12426 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12428 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12429 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12430 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12431 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12432 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12433 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12434 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12435 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12441 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12443 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12450 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12451 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12454 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12455 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12456 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12457 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12458 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12459 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12460 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12461 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12462 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12463 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12464 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12465 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12466 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12467 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12469 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12470 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12471 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12472 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12473 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12474 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12475 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12476 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12477 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12478 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12479 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12480 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12481 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12482 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12483 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12484 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12489 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12491 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12492 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12493 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12494 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12495 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12496 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12501 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12503 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12504 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12505 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12506 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12508 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12509 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12510 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12511 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12512 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12513 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12514 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12515 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12516 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12517 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12522 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12524 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12525 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12527 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12528 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12529 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12530 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12531 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12536 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12538 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12539 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12540 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12541 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12542 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12543 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12544 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12545 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12546 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12547 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12548 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12549 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12550 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12551 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12552 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12553 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12554 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12555 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12556 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12557 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12558 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12563 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12565 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12566 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12567 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12568 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12569 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12570 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12571 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12572 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12573 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12574 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12575 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12576 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12577 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12578 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12583 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12584 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12587 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean false
12589 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12590 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12591 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12592 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12593 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12594 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
12596 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12597 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12598 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12599 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12600 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12603 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12604 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12605 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12608 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12609 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12610 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12611 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12612 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12614 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12615 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12616 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12617 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12618 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12620 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12621 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12622 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12623 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12625 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12626 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12627 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12628 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12629 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12631 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12632 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12633 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12634 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12636 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12637 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12638 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12639 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12641 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12642 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12643 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12644 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12645 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12648 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12649 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12650 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12651 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12653 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12654 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12655 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12656 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12657 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12659 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12660 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12661 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12662 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12663 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12665 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12666 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12667 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12670 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12671 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12672 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12673 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12675 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12676 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12677 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12678 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12680 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12681 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12682 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12683 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12685 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12686 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12687 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12688 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12690 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12691 .cindex "admin user"
12692 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12693 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12694 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12695 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12696 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12697 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12698 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12700 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12701 .cindex "domain literal"
12702 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12703 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12704 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
12705 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
12707 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
12708 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
12709 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
12710 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
12711 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
12712 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
12713 the local host's IP addresses.
12716 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
12717 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
12718 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
12719 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
12720 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
12721 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
12722 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
12723 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
12724 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
12726 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
12727 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
12728 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
12729 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
12730 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
12731 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
12732 experiment if they wish.
12734 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
12735 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
12736 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
12737 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
12738 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
12739 suitable setting is:
12741 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
12742 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
12744 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
12746 dns_check_names_pattern =
12748 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
12751 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
12752 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
12753 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
12754 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
12755 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
12756 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
12757 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
12758 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
12759 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
12760 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
12761 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
12763 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
12764 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
12765 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
12766 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
12767 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
12768 which Exim advertises AUTH.
12770 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
12771 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
12772 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
12773 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
12775 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
12777 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12778 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
12779 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
12780 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
12783 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
12784 .cindex "thawing messages"
12785 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
12786 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
12787 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
12788 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
12789 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
12790 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
12792 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
12793 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
12794 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
12796 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
12797 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
12798 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
12800 sophie:/var/run/sophie
12802 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
12803 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
12807 .option bi_command main string unset
12809 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
12810 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
12811 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
12812 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
12815 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
12816 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
12817 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
12818 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
12819 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
12820 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
12823 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
12824 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
12825 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
12826 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
12828 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
12829 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
12830 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
12831 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
12832 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
12833 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
12834 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
12835 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
12836 point at which the error was detected are returned.
12837 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
12839 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
12840 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
12841 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
12842 &%bounce_return_body%&.
12845 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
12846 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
12847 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
12848 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
12849 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
12850 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
12851 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
12852 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
12853 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
12855 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
12856 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
12857 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
12858 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
12859 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
12862 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
12863 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
12864 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
12865 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
12866 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
12867 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
12868 connection. A typical setting might be:
12870 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12872 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
12874 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12876 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
12879 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
12880 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
12881 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
12882 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
12883 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12884 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12887 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
12888 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
12889 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12890 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12893 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
12894 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
12895 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12896 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12899 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
12900 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
12901 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12902 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12905 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
12906 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
12907 callout verification. The default value is
12909 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
12911 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
12914 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
12915 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12918 .option check_log_space main integer 0
12919 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12921 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
12922 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
12923 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
12924 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
12925 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
12926 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
12927 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
12928 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
12929 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
12930 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
12933 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
12934 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12937 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
12938 .cindex "checking disk space"
12939 .cindex "disk space, checking"
12940 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
12941 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
12942 message is accepted.
12944 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12945 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12946 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12947 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12948 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
12949 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
12950 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
12951 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
12954 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
12955 either value is greater than zero, for example:
12957 check_spool_space = 10M
12958 check_spool_inodes = 100
12960 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
12961 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
12964 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
12965 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
12966 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
12968 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
12969 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
12970 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
12971 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
12972 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
12973 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
12975 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
12976 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
12978 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
12979 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
12980 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
12982 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
12983 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
12984 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12985 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
12986 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
12987 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
12989 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
12990 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
12991 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
12992 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
12993 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
12994 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
12995 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
12997 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
12998 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13000 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13001 .cindex "warning of delay"
13002 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13003 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13004 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13005 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13006 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13007 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13008 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13011 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13013 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13014 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13015 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13016 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13020 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13021 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13023 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13026 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13027 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13028 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13029 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13030 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13031 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13032 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13033 not sent. The default is:
13035 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13036 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13037 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13038 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13041 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13042 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13043 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13044 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13046 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13047 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13048 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13049 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13050 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13051 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13052 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13053 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13055 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13056 .cindex "load average"
13057 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13058 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13059 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13060 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13061 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13064 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13065 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13066 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13067 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13068 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13069 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13070 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13071 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13073 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13074 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13075 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13076 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13077 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13078 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13079 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13080 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13082 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13083 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13084 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13085 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13088 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13089 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13090 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13091 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13092 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13093 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13094 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13097 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13098 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13099 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13100 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13101 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13102 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13103 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13104 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13105 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13106 by a setting such as this:
13108 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13110 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13111 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13112 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13113 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13114 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13115 options are applied after this global option.
13117 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13118 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13119 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13120 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13121 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13122 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13123 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13124 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13125 value of this option. The default pattern is
13127 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13128 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13130 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13131 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13132 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13133 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13134 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13137 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13138 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13139 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13141 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13142 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13143 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13144 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13146 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13147 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13148 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13149 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13150 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13151 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13152 domain matches this list.
13154 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13155 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13156 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13159 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13160 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13161 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13162 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13163 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13164 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13165 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13166 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13167 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13168 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13172 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13173 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13176 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13177 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13178 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13179 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13181 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13182 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13183 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13184 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13185 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13186 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13188 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13190 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13191 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13193 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13194 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13195 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13196 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13197 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13198 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13199 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13200 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13201 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13204 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13205 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13206 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13207 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13208 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13209 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13210 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13211 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13212 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13214 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13215 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13216 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13217 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13218 are examined. For example:
13220 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13221 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13222 postmaster@mydomain.example
13224 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13225 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13226 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13227 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13228 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13229 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13230 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13233 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13234 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13235 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13237 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13239 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13240 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13241 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13242 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13243 overrides the default.
13245 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13246 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13247 and warning messages. For example:
13249 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13251 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13252 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13253 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13254 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13258 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13259 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13260 .cindex "Exim group"
13261 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13262 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13263 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13264 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13265 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13269 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13270 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13271 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13272 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13273 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13274 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13276 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13277 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13278 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13279 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13282 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13283 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13284 .cindex "Exim user"
13285 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13286 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13287 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13288 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13290 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13291 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13292 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13293 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13296 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13297 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13298 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13299 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13302 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13303 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13305 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13306 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13308 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13309 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13310 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13311 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13312 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13313 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13314 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13315 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13316 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13317 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13321 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13322 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13323 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13324 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13325 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13326 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13327 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13328 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13331 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13332 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13333 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13334 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13338 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13339 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13340 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13341 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13342 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13343 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13344 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13345 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13346 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13347 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13348 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13349 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13350 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13351 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13352 logging that you require.
13355 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13357 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13358 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13359 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13360 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13361 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13362 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13363 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13364 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13366 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13367 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13368 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13371 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13372 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13373 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13374 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13376 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13380 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13381 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13384 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
13385 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13386 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13388 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
13389 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13390 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13392 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
13393 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13394 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13397 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13398 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13399 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13400 implementations of TLS.
13403 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13404 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13405 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13406 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13407 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13408 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13412 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13413 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13414 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13415 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13416 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13417 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13418 sections are rejected.
13421 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13422 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13423 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13424 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13425 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13426 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13427 zero means &"no limit"&.
13432 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13433 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13434 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13435 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13436 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13437 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13438 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13439 if you want to do semantic checking.
13440 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13444 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13445 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13446 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13447 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13448 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13449 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13450 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13452 helo_allow_chars = _
13454 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13457 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13458 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13459 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13460 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13461 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13462 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13463 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13467 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13468 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13469 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13470 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13471 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13472 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13473 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13474 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13475 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13476 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13477 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13478 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13480 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13481 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13482 EHLO command either:
13485 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13487 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13488 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13489 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13490 calling host address, or
13492 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13493 available) yields the calling host address.
13496 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13497 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13498 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
13500 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13501 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13502 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13503 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13504 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13505 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13506 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13507 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13508 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13511 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13512 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13513 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13514 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13515 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13516 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13517 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13518 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13519 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13521 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13522 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13523 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13524 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13525 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13527 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13528 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13529 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13530 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13533 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13534 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13535 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13536 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13537 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13538 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13539 default configuration file contains
13543 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13544 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13546 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13547 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13548 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13550 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13551 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13552 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13553 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13554 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
13555 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13558 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13559 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13560 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13561 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13562 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13565 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13566 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13567 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13568 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13572 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13573 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13574 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13575 as soon as the connection is made.
13576 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13577 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13578 connections immediately.
13580 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13581 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13582 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13583 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13584 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13587 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13588 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13589 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13590 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13591 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13592 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13593 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13594 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13595 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13597 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13599 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13603 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13604 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13605 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13606 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13607 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13609 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13610 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13612 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13613 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13614 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13615 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13616 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13617 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13618 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13621 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13622 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13623 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13624 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13625 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13629 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13630 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13631 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13632 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13633 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13634 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13636 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13637 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13638 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13639 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13640 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13641 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13642 for frozen messages. For example,
13644 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13646 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13647 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13648 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13649 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13650 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13651 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13654 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13655 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13656 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13657 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13658 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13659 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13660 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13661 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13662 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13663 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13666 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13667 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13670 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
13671 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13672 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13673 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13677 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
13678 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
13679 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
13680 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
13681 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
13685 .option ldap_version main integer unset
13686 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
13687 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
13688 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
13689 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
13690 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
13691 has been built with LDAP support.
13695 .option local_from_check main boolean true
13696 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
13697 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
13698 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13699 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
13700 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
13701 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
13703 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
13704 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
13705 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
13707 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
13708 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
13709 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
13710 and the default qualify domain.
13712 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
13713 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
13714 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
13715 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
13717 .cindex "envelope sender"
13718 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
13719 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
13720 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
13722 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
13723 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
13724 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13729 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
13730 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
13731 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
13732 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
13733 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
13734 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
13735 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
13738 local_from_prefix = *-
13740 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
13742 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
13744 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
13745 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
13749 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
13750 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
13753 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
13754 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
13755 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
13756 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
13757 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
13758 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
13759 &%local_interfaces%& is
13761 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13763 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
13765 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13768 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
13769 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
13770 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
13771 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
13772 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
13773 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
13774 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
13775 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
13779 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
13780 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
13781 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13782 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
13783 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
13784 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
13785 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
13786 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13791 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
13792 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
13793 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
13794 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13795 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
13796 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
13797 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
13798 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
13799 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
13800 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
13801 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
13802 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
13803 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
13804 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
13805 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
13809 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
13810 .cindex "log" "file path for"
13811 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
13812 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
13813 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
13814 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
13815 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
13816 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
13817 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
13818 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
13819 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
13820 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
13821 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
13822 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
13825 .option log_selector main string unset
13826 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13827 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
13828 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
13829 minus characters. For example:
13831 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
13833 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
13834 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
13837 .option log_timezone main boolean false
13838 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
13839 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13840 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13841 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
13842 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
13843 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
13844 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
13845 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
13846 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
13847 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
13848 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
13849 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
13852 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
13853 .cindex "too many open files"
13854 .cindex "open files, too many"
13855 .cindex "file" "too many open"
13856 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
13857 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
13858 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
13859 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
13860 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
13861 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
13862 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
13863 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
13864 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
13865 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
13866 &%lookup_open_max%&.
13869 .option max_username_length main integer 0
13870 .cindex "length of login name"
13871 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
13872 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
13873 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
13874 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
13875 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
13876 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
13879 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
13880 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
13881 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
13882 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13883 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13884 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
13885 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
13886 option is set true, this no longer happens.
13889 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
13890 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
13891 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
13892 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13893 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13894 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
13895 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
13898 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
13899 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
13900 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
13901 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
13902 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
13903 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
13904 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
13905 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
13906 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
13907 empty string, the option is ignored.
13910 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
13911 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
13912 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
13913 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
13914 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
13915 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
13916 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
13917 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
13918 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
13919 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
13920 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
13921 colons will become hyphens.
13924 .option message_logs main boolean true
13925 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
13926 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
13927 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
13928 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
13929 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
13930 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
13931 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
13932 which is not affected by this option.
13935 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
13936 .cindex "message" "size limit"
13937 .cindex "limit" "message size"
13938 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
13939 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
13940 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
13941 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
13942 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
13943 optionally followed by K or M.
13945 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
13946 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
13947 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
13948 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
13949 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
13951 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
13952 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
13953 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
13954 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
13955 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
13956 message that an individual transport can process.
13959 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
13960 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
13961 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
13963 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
13965 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
13966 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
13967 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
13968 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
13969 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
13972 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
13973 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
13974 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
13975 contains a full description of this facility.
13979 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
13980 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
13981 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
13982 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
13983 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
13986 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
13987 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
13988 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
13989 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
13990 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
13993 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
13994 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
13995 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
13996 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
13997 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
13999 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14000 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14003 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14005 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14006 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14010 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14011 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14012 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14013 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14014 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14017 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14018 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14019 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14020 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14021 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14022 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14023 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14024 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14025 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14026 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14029 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14030 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14031 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14032 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14033 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14034 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14035 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14038 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14039 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14040 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14043 .option perl_startup main string unset
14044 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14045 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14048 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14049 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14050 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14051 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14052 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14053 PostgreSQL support.
14056 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14057 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14058 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14059 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14060 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14063 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14065 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14067 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14068 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14069 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14072 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14073 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14074 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14075 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14076 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14077 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14078 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14079 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14080 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14083 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14084 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14085 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14086 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14087 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14088 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14089 volume of mail. Use with care!
14092 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14093 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14094 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14095 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14096 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14097 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14098 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14099 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14100 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14101 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14103 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14104 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14105 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14106 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14107 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14108 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14111 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14112 .cindex "printing characters"
14113 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14114 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14115 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14116 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14117 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14118 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14121 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14122 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14123 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14124 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14125 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14129 .option process_log_path main string unset
14130 .cindex "process log path"
14131 .cindex "log" "process log"
14132 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14133 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14134 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14135 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14136 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14137 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14138 different spool directories.
14141 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14145 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14146 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14147 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14150 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14151 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14152 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14153 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14154 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14155 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14156 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14157 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14158 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14160 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14161 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14162 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14163 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14164 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14165 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14166 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14169 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14170 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14171 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14175 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14176 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14177 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14178 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14179 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14180 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14181 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14182 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14185 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14187 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14188 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14189 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14192 .option queue_only main boolean false
14193 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14194 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14195 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14196 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14197 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14198 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14200 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14201 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14202 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14203 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14206 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14207 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14208 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14209 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14210 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14211 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14212 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14213 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14214 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14216 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14218 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14219 &_/some/file_& exists.
14222 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14223 .cindex "load average"
14224 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14225 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14226 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14227 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14228 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14229 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14230 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14233 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14234 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14235 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14236 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14239 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14240 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14241 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14242 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14243 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14244 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14245 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14246 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14247 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14248 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14249 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14250 re-evaluated for each message.
14253 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14254 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14255 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14256 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14257 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14258 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14261 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14262 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14263 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14264 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14265 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14266 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14267 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14268 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14269 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14270 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14271 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14272 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14273 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14277 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14278 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14279 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14280 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14281 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14282 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14283 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14284 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14285 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14287 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14288 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14289 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14290 the daemon's command line.
14292 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14293 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14294 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14295 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14296 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14297 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14298 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14299 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14300 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14301 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14302 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14303 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14304 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14308 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14309 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14310 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14311 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14312 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14313 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14314 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14316 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14317 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14318 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14319 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14320 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14321 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14322 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14323 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14324 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14325 header lines. The default setting is:
14328 received_header_text = Received: \
14329 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14330 {${if def:sender_ident \
14331 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14332 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14333 by $primary_hostname \
14334 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14335 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14336 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14337 ${if def:sender_address \
14338 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14339 id $message_exim_id\
14340 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14343 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14344 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14345 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14346 header lines such as the following:
14348 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14349 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14350 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14351 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14352 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14353 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14354 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14356 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14357 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14358 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14359 message was accepted.
14362 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14363 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14364 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14365 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14366 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14367 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14368 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14369 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14372 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14373 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14374 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14375 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14376 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14377 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14378 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14379 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14380 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14381 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14382 option was not set.
14385 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14386 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14387 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14388 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14389 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14390 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14391 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14392 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14395 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14396 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14397 RCPT commands in a single message.
14400 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14401 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14402 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14403 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14404 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14405 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14406 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14409 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14410 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14411 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14412 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14413 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14414 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14415 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14416 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14417 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14418 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14419 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14420 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14421 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14422 tagged with its process id.
14424 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14425 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14426 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14427 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14430 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14431 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14432 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14433 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14434 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14435 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14436 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14437 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14438 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14439 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14440 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14442 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14443 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14444 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14445 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14448 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14449 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14450 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14451 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14452 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14454 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14456 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14457 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14460 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14461 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14462 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14463 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14464 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14468 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14469 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14470 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14471 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14472 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14473 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14474 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14478 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14479 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14480 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14481 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14482 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14483 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14484 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14485 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14486 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14487 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14490 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14491 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14494 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14496 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14497 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14500 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14501 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14502 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14503 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14504 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14507 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14508 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14509 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14510 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14511 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14512 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14513 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14514 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14515 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14516 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14519 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14520 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14521 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14522 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14523 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14524 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14525 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14526 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14527 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14528 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14529 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14533 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14534 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14535 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14537 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14538 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14539 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14540 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14541 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14542 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14544 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
14545 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
14546 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
14547 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
14550 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
14551 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
14552 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
14553 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
14554 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
14555 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
14556 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
14557 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
14559 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
14560 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
14561 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
14562 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
14563 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
14564 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
14565 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
14566 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
14569 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14570 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
14571 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
14572 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
14576 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14577 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14579 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
14580 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
14581 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
14582 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
14583 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
14584 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
14585 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
14586 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
14587 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
14591 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
14592 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
14593 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
14594 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
14595 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
14596 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
14597 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
14598 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
14599 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
14600 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
14601 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
14603 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
14604 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
14605 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
14606 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
14607 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
14608 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
14612 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
14613 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14614 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14615 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
14616 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
14617 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
14618 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
14619 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
14620 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
14621 to all messages received in the same connection.
14623 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
14624 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
14625 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
14626 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
14629 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14630 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14632 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
14633 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
14634 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14635 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
14636 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
14637 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
14638 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
14639 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
14640 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
14641 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
14642 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
14643 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
14644 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
14647 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
14648 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
14649 .cindex "host" "reserved"
14650 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
14651 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
14652 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
14653 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
14654 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
14655 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
14656 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
14657 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
14660 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
14661 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
14662 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
14663 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
14666 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
14667 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
14668 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
14669 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14670 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
14671 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
14672 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
14673 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
14674 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
14676 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
14677 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
14678 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
14679 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
14681 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
14682 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
14683 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
14684 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
14685 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
14688 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
14689 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
14692 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
14693 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
14694 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
14695 &%helo_data%& value.
14697 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
14698 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
14699 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
14700 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
14701 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
14702 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
14703 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
14705 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
14706 $version_number $tod_full
14708 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
14709 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
14710 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
14711 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
14712 multiline response).
14715 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
14716 .cindex "checking disk space"
14717 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14718 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14719 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
14720 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
14721 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
14722 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
14723 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
14726 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
14727 .cindex "connection backlog"
14728 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
14729 .cindex "backlog of connections"
14730 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
14731 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
14732 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
14733 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
14734 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
14735 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
14736 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
14737 attacks by SYN flooding.
14740 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
14741 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
14742 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
14743 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
14744 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
14745 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
14746 fewer, but they still exist.
14748 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
14749 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
14750 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
14751 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
14752 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
14753 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
14754 does detect many instances.
14756 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
14757 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
14758 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
14759 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
14763 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
14764 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
14765 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14766 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
14767 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
14768 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
14769 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
14770 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
14773 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
14774 $sender_host_address
14776 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
14777 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
14778 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
14779 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
14780 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
14784 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
14785 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
14786 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
14787 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
14788 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
14791 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
14792 .cindex "load average"
14793 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
14794 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
14795 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
14796 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
14797 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
14798 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
14802 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
14803 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
14804 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
14805 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
14806 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
14808 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
14810 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
14811 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
14812 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
14813 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
14814 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
14816 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
14817 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
14818 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
14819 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
14820 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
14821 not count towards the limit.
14825 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
14826 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
14827 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
14828 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
14829 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
14832 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
14833 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
14837 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14838 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
14839 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
14840 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
14841 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
14842 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
14845 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
14846 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
14847 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
14848 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
14850 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
14851 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
14852 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
14853 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
14857 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
14859 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
14860 fractional parts are allowed here.
14862 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
14864 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
14865 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
14868 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
14869 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
14871 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
14872 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
14874 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
14875 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
14876 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
14877 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
14880 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
14881 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14884 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
14885 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14888 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
14889 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
14890 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
14891 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
14892 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
14893 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
14894 the message is abandoned.
14895 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
14897 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
14898 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
14900 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
14901 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
14905 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
14906 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
14907 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
14908 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
14909 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
14912 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14913 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
14914 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
14917 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
14918 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
14919 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
14920 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
14921 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
14922 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
14923 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
14924 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
14925 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
14926 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
14928 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
14929 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
14932 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
14933 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
14934 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
14935 The default value is
14939 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
14943 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
14944 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
14945 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
14946 .cindex "directories, multiple"
14947 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
14948 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
14949 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
14950 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
14951 arrival of the message.
14953 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
14954 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
14955 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
14956 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
14957 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
14959 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
14960 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
14961 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
14962 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
14963 automatically deleted.
14965 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
14966 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
14967 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
14968 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
14969 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
14970 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
14971 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
14972 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
14973 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
14976 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
14977 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
14978 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
14979 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
14980 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
14981 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
14982 &$primary_hostname$&.
14984 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
14985 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
14986 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
14987 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
14988 as failures in the configuration file.
14990 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
14991 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
14993 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
14994 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
14995 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
14996 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
14998 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
14999 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15000 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15001 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15002 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15003 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15005 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15006 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15007 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15008 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15009 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15010 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15011 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15014 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15015 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15016 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15017 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15018 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15019 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15020 domain causes a syntax error.
15021 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15025 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15026 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15027 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15028 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15029 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15030 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15031 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15032 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15033 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15034 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15035 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15036 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15039 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15040 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15041 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15042 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15043 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15044 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15045 details of Exim's logging.
15049 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15050 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15051 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15052 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15053 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15057 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15058 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15059 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15060 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15061 details of Exim's logging.
15064 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15065 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15066 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15067 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15068 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15069 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15070 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15071 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15072 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15073 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15074 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15077 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15078 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15079 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15080 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15081 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15082 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15085 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15086 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15087 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15088 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15089 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15091 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15092 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15093 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15094 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15095 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15097 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15098 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15099 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15100 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15101 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15102 contains the pipe command.
15105 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15106 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15107 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15108 is used in a system filter.
15110 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15111 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15112 If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
15113 process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
15114 process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15115 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15116 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15117 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15118 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15120 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15121 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15122 transport option overrides. Normally you should set &%system_filter_user%& if
15123 your system filter generates these kinds of delivery.
15126 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15127 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15128 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15129 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15130 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15131 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15132 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15133 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15134 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15135 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15136 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15137 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15141 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15142 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15143 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15144 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15145 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15146 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15147 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15148 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15149 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15150 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15152 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15153 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15154 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15157 .option timezone main string unset
15158 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15159 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15160 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15161 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15162 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15166 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15167 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15168 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15169 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15170 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15171 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15174 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15175 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15176 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15177 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15178 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15179 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15180 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15181 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15184 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15185 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15186 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15187 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15188 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15189 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15190 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15192 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15193 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15194 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15195 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15198 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15199 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15200 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15201 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15202 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15205 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15206 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15207 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15208 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15209 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15210 ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15213 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15214 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15215 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15216 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15217 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15221 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15222 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15223 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15224 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15225 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15226 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15227 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15230 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15231 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15232 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15233 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15234 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15235 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15239 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15240 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15241 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15242 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15243 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15244 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15245 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15246 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15247 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15248 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15249 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15252 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15253 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15254 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15255 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15258 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15259 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15260 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15261 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15262 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15263 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15264 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15265 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15266 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15269 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15270 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15271 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15272 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15273 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15274 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15275 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15276 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15278 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15279 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15280 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15281 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15282 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15283 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15284 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15286 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15287 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15288 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15289 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15290 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15291 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15292 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15295 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15299 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15300 .cindex "trusted groups"
15301 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15302 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15303 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15304 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15305 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15306 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15307 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15310 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15311 .cindex "trusted users"
15312 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15313 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15314 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15315 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15316 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15317 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15318 Exim user are trusted.
15320 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15321 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15322 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15323 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15324 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15325 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15326 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15327 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15328 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15331 .option unknown_username main string unset
15332 See &%unknown_login%&.
15334 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15335 .cindex "trusted users"
15336 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15337 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15338 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15339 .cindex "envelope sender"
15340 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15341 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15342 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15343 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15344 is used) is ignored.
15346 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15347 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15349 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15351 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15352 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15353 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15354 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15355 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15356 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15357 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15358 followed by a hyphen
15359 by a setting like this:
15361 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15363 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15364 restriction, you can use
15366 untrusted_set_sender = *
15368 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15369 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15370 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15371 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15372 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15373 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15374 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15375 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15377 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15378 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15379 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15380 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15384 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15385 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15386 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15387 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15388 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15389 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15390 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15391 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15392 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15393 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15395 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15396 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15398 The pattern can be seen by running
15400 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15402 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15403 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15404 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15405 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15406 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15407 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15410 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15411 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15414 .option warn_message_file main string unset
15415 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15416 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15417 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15418 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15419 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15420 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15421 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15424 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15425 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15426 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15427 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15428 .ecindex IIDconfima
15429 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
15434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15435 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15437 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15438 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15439 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15440 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15441 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
15443 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15444 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15445 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15446 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15447 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15451 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
15452 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15453 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15454 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15455 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15456 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15457 delivery of the address to be deferred.
15459 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15460 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15461 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15462 routers, and the eventual transport.
15464 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15465 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15466 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15467 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15468 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15470 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15471 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15472 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15473 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15474 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15476 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15477 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15478 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15480 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15482 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15484 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15486 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15487 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15489 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15490 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15491 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15492 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15493 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15494 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15495 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15499 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15501 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15502 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15503 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15504 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15505 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15510 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15511 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15512 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15513 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15514 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15515 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15516 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15517 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15518 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
15519 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
15522 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
15524 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
15527 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
15529 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
15530 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
15531 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
15532 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
15535 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
15536 .cindex "case of local parts"
15537 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
15538 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
15539 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
15540 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
15541 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
15542 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
15543 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
15546 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15547 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
15548 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
15549 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
15550 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
15551 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
15552 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
15553 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
15554 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15556 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15557 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
15558 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15559 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
15563 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
15564 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
15565 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
15566 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
15568 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15569 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15570 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
15571 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
15572 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15573 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15574 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15575 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
15576 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
15577 the router is skipped.
15579 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15580 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
15581 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
15582 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
15583 setting to achieve this. For example:
15585 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15587 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
15588 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
15589 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
15593 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
15594 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
15595 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15596 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
15597 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
15598 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
15599 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
15600 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15602 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15603 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15605 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15606 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15607 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15609 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15611 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15613 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15615 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15616 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15617 be specified using &%condition%&.
15621 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
15622 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
15623 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
15624 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15625 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15626 output, and Exim carries on processing.
15627 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15628 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
15629 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
15630 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
15631 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
15632 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15636 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
15637 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
15638 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
15639 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
15640 transport option of the same name.
15643 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
15644 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
15645 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
15646 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
15647 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
15648 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
15649 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
15650 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
15654 .option driver routers string unset
15655 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
15660 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
15661 .cindex "envelope sender"
15662 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
15663 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
15664 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
15665 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
15666 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
15667 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
15668 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
15670 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
15671 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
15672 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
15675 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
15676 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
15677 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
15678 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
15680 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
15681 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
15682 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
15683 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
15689 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
15690 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
15691 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
15692 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
15693 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
15695 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15696 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
15697 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
15698 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
15699 setting &%return_path%&.
15701 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
15702 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
15703 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
15707 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
15708 .cindex "address" "testing"
15709 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
15710 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
15711 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
15712 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
15713 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
15714 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
15715 on for the system alias file.
15716 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15719 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
15720 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
15721 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
15725 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
15726 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
15727 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
15728 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
15732 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
15733 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15734 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
15738 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
15739 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15740 verifying a sender, verification fails.
15744 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
15745 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
15746 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
15747 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
15748 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
15749 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
15750 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
15751 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
15752 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
15754 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
15755 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
15756 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
15757 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
15758 transport for further details.
15761 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
15762 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
15763 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15764 .cindex "transport" "local"
15765 .cindex "router" "setting group"
15766 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
15767 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
15769 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
15770 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
15771 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
15772 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
15773 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15777 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
15778 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
15779 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
15780 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15781 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15782 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15783 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
15784 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
15785 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
15786 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
15787 &"see"& the added header lines.
15789 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
15790 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
15791 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
15792 failures are treated as configuration errors.
15794 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15795 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15797 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
15798 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
15799 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15800 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
15801 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
15802 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
15803 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
15804 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
15805 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
15806 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
15810 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
15811 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
15812 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
15813 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15814 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15815 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15816 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
15817 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
15818 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
15819 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
15820 &"see"& the original header lines.
15822 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
15823 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
15824 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
15827 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15828 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15830 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15831 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
15832 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
15833 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
15836 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
15837 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
15838 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
15839 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
15840 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
15841 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
15842 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
15845 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
15849 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
15851 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
15852 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
15853 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
15854 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
15855 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
15856 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
15858 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
15859 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
15861 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
15862 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
15864 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
15865 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
15867 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
15868 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
15869 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
15870 domain that is being routed.
15872 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
15873 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
15876 .option initgroups routers boolean false
15877 .cindex "additional groups"
15878 .cindex "groups" "additional"
15879 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15880 .cindex "transport" "local"
15881 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
15882 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
15883 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
15884 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
15885 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15889 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
15890 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
15891 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
15892 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
15893 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
15894 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
15897 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
15898 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
15899 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
15900 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
15901 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
15902 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
15903 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
15904 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
15905 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
15907 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15908 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
15909 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
15910 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
15911 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
15912 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
15913 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
15914 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
15915 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
15916 the relevant transport.
15918 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
15919 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
15920 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
15923 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
15924 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
15925 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
15926 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
15927 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
15931 local_part_prefix = real-
15933 transport = local_delivery
15935 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
15936 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
15938 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
15939 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
15942 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
15943 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
15944 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
15945 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
15948 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
15949 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
15953 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
15954 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
15955 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
15956 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
15957 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
15958 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
15959 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
15960 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
15961 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
15965 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
15966 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
15970 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
15971 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
15972 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
15973 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
15974 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15976 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
15977 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
15980 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
15982 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
15983 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
15984 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
15985 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
15986 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
15987 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
15988 each virtual domain:
15992 local_parts = postmaster
15993 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
15997 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
15998 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
15999 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16000 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16001 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16002 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16003 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16004 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16005 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16006 redirect addresses.
16010 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16011 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16012 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16013 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16014 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16015 delivery to be deferred.
16017 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16018 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16020 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16021 means of the setting
16025 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16026 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16027 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16029 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16030 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16031 controls what happens next.
16034 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16035 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16036 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16037 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16038 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16039 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16040 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16041 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16043 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16044 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16045 applies to all of them.
16049 .option pass_router routers string unset
16050 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16051 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16052 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16053 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16054 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16055 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16056 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16057 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16058 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16059 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16063 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16064 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16065 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16066 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16067 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16068 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16070 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16071 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16072 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16073 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16077 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16078 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16079 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16080 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16081 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16082 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16083 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16085 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16086 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16087 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16088 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16090 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16091 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16092 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16093 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16094 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16097 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16098 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16101 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16102 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16103 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16104 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16105 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16106 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16107 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16108 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16110 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16111 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16112 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16113 operates as follows:
16115 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16116 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16117 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16118 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16121 require_files = mail:/some/file
16122 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16124 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16125 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16127 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16128 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16129 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16130 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16132 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16133 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16134 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16135 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16136 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16138 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16139 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16140 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16141 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16142 check again in that process.
16144 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16145 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16146 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16147 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16148 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16149 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16150 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16152 require_files = +/some/file
16154 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16155 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16156 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16160 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16161 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16162 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16163 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16164 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16165 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16166 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16167 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16170 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16171 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16172 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16173 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16174 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16177 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16178 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16179 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16183 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16184 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16185 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16187 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16188 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16189 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16190 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16191 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16192 cause the router to defer.
16194 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16195 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16197 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16199 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16200 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16202 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16203 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16204 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16205 of these values that is set:
16208 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16210 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16212 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16214 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16217 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16218 router, but not for the transport.
16222 .option self routers string freeze
16223 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16224 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16225 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16226 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16227 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16228 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16230 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16231 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16232 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16233 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16234 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16236 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16237 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16238 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16239 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16240 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16245 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16247 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16248 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16249 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16250 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16252 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16253 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16254 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16259 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16260 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16261 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16262 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16263 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16264 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16270 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16271 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16272 be passed to the next router.
16275 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16278 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16279 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16280 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16281 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16282 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16283 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16288 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16289 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16290 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16291 address matches something on the list.
16292 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16295 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16296 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16297 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16298 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16299 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16300 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16301 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16305 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16306 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16307 .cindex "packet radio"
16308 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16309 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16310 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16311 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16312 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16313 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16314 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16315 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16317 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16318 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16319 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16320 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16321 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16322 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16323 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16324 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16325 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16326 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16328 translate_ip_address = \
16329 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16332 The file would contain lines like
16334 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16335 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16337 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16342 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16343 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16344 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16345 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16346 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16347 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16348 delivery is deferred.
16350 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16351 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16352 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16356 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16357 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16358 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16359 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16360 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16361 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16362 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16363 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16364 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16365 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16366 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16372 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16373 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16374 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16375 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16376 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16377 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16378 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16379 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16380 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16381 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16383 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16384 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16385 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16386 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16387 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16389 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16395 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16396 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16397 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16398 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16399 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16400 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16401 delivery to be deferred.
16403 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16404 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16405 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16406 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16407 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16408 sometimes true and sometimes false).
16410 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16411 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16412 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16413 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16414 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16415 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16416 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16417 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16419 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16420 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16421 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16422 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16423 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16424 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16425 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16426 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16427 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16428 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16430 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16431 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16432 subsequent routers.
16435 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
16436 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16437 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16438 .cindex "transport" "local"
16439 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16440 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16441 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16442 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16443 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16444 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16445 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16446 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16447 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16448 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16449 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16450 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16454 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
16455 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16456 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16459 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16460 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16462 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16463 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16464 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16465 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16466 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16467 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16469 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16470 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16471 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16475 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16476 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16478 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16479 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16483 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16484 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16485 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16486 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16488 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16489 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16496 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16497 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16499 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16500 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
16501 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16502 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16503 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16504 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16505 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16506 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16507 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16511 domains = mydomain.example
16513 transport = local_delivery
16515 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16516 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16517 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
16518 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
16525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16528 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
16529 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
16530 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
16531 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16532 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16533 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
16535 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
16536 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16537 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16538 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
16541 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16542 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16543 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16544 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16545 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16546 generic option, the router declines.
16548 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16549 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
16550 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16552 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16553 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16554 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
16555 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16556 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
16557 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
16560 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
16561 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16562 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16563 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16564 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
16565 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16567 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
16568 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16569 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
16570 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16571 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
16572 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
16573 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
16574 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
16575 case routing fails.
16580 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
16581 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
16582 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
16584 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
16585 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
16586 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16587 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16588 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16589 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16590 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16593 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
16594 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
16595 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16596 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16597 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
16598 required. For example,
16602 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16603 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16604 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16605 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
16606 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16609 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16610 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16611 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
16612 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16613 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16614 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16616 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16617 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16618 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16619 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16620 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16621 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16622 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
16623 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16625 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
16626 when there is a DNS lookup error.
16630 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16631 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
16632 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
16633 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16634 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16635 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
16636 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
16639 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
16641 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
16642 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
16643 the address record.
16646 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16647 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16648 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
16649 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16654 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
16655 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16656 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
16657 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
16658 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
16659 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
16660 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
16661 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
16662 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
16667 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
16668 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
16669 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
16670 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
16671 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
16672 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
16673 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
16674 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
16675 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
16676 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
16677 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
16679 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
16680 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
16683 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
16684 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
16685 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
16686 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
16687 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
16691 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
16692 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
16693 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
16694 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16695 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16696 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16697 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16698 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16700 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16701 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
16702 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
16703 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
16704 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16705 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16706 without processing them independently,
16707 provided the following conditions are met:
16710 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
16711 &%headers_remove%&.
16713 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
16720 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
16721 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16722 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
16723 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
16724 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
16725 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
16726 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
16727 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
16728 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
16729 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
16731 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
16732 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
16737 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16738 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16739 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
16740 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16745 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
16746 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
16747 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
16748 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
16751 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
16753 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
16754 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
16755 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
16756 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
16757 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
16758 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
16761 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
16762 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
16763 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
16764 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
16765 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
16767 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
16768 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
16769 such as that implied by
16773 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
16774 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
16775 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
16776 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
16786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16789 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
16790 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
16791 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
16792 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
16793 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
16794 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
16795 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
16796 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
16797 router handles the address
16801 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
16802 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
16803 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
16805 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
16807 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
16808 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
16810 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
16811 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
16812 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
16813 &%self%& option determines what happens.
16815 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
16816 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
16817 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
16818 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
16822 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16823 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16825 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
16826 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
16827 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
16828 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
16829 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
16830 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
16833 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
16835 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
16837 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
16838 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
16839 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
16840 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
16841 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
16842 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
16843 must not be specified for it.
16845 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
16846 .option hosts iplookup string unset
16847 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
16848 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
16849 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
16850 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
16851 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
16854 .option optional iplookup boolean false
16855 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
16856 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
16857 delivery to the address is deferred.
16860 .option port iplookup integer 0
16861 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
16862 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
16866 .option protocol iplookup string udp
16867 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
16868 protocols is to be used.
16871 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
16872 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
16875 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
16877 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
16878 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
16881 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
16882 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
16883 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
16884 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
16885 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
16886 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
16887 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
16888 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
16891 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
16892 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
16893 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
16894 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
16895 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
16896 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
16897 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
16898 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
16899 following could be used:
16901 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
16902 reroute = $local_part@$1
16905 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
16906 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
16907 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
16908 call. It does not apply to UDP.
16913 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16914 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16916 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
16917 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
16918 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
16919 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
16920 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
16921 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
16922 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
16923 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
16924 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
16925 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
16927 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
16928 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
16929 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
16930 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
16931 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
16932 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
16933 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
16936 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
16937 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
16938 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
16939 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
16940 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
16941 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
16942 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
16945 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
16946 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
16947 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
16948 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
16949 below, following the list of private options.
16952 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
16954 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
16955 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
16957 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
16958 See &%host_find_failed%&.
16960 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
16961 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
16962 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
16963 of the following values:
16972 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
16973 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
16974 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
16977 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
16978 router only if &%more%& is true.
16980 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
16981 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
16982 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
16983 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
16985 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
16986 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
16987 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
16990 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
16991 .cindex "randomized host list"
16992 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
16993 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
16994 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
16995 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
16996 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
16997 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
16998 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
16999 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17001 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17002 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17003 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17004 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17006 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17008 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17009 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17010 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17011 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17012 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17015 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17016 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17017 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17020 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17022 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17023 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17027 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17028 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17029 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17030 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17033 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17034 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17035 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17036 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17037 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17038 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17039 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17040 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17042 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17043 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17044 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17045 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17046 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17047 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17048 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17049 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17054 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17055 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17056 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17057 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17058 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17059 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17061 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17063 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17067 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17068 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17070 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17071 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17072 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17073 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17074 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17075 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17076 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17077 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17078 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17079 in a &%route_list%&).
17081 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17082 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17083 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17084 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17088 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17089 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17090 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17091 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17092 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17093 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17094 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17097 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17098 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17100 This data can be accessed by setting
17102 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17104 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17105 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17106 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17107 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17108 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17113 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17114 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17115 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17116 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17117 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17118 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17119 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17121 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17122 variables are set during its expansion:
17125 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17126 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17127 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17129 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17132 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17134 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17137 .vindex "&$value$&"
17138 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17139 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17141 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17145 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17146 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17150 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17151 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17152 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17153 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17154 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17155 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17158 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17159 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17160 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17162 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17163 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17166 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17167 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17168 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17169 number follows. For example:
17171 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17175 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17176 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17177 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17178 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17179 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17182 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17183 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17184 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17185 records in the DNS. For example:
17187 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17189 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17192 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17194 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17195 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17196 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17197 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17198 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17199 happens is controlled by the
17200 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17201 &%self%& option of the router.
17203 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17204 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17205 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17206 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17207 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17208 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17209 defined by MX preferences.
17211 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17212 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17213 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17215 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17216 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17217 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17218 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17220 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17221 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17224 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17225 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17226 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17228 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17229 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17233 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17234 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17235 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17236 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17237 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17238 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17239 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17242 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17243 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17245 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17246 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17248 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17249 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17250 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17252 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17253 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17254 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17259 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17260 domain2 host4:host5
17262 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17263 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17264 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17265 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17268 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17269 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17270 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17271 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17276 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17277 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17280 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17281 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17285 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17286 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17287 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17290 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17291 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17292 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17293 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17295 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17297 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17298 your first router something like this:
17301 driver = manualroute
17302 domains = !+local_domains
17303 transport = remote_smtp
17304 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17306 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17307 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17308 they are tried in order
17309 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17310 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17313 driver = manualroute
17314 transport = remote_smtp
17315 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17317 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17318 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17319 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17320 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17321 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17322 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17323 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17324 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17327 .cindex "mail hub example"
17328 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17329 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17330 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17331 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17332 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17333 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17334 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17335 lookup is easier to manage.
17337 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17338 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17342 driver = manualroute
17343 transport = remote_smtp
17344 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17346 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17347 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17348 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17349 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17350 domain can be used to find the host:
17353 driver = manualroute
17354 transport = remote_smtp
17355 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17357 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17358 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17359 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17363 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17364 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17365 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17366 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17367 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17368 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17371 driver = manualroute
17372 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17373 route_list = saved.domain.example
17375 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17376 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17377 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17380 driver = manualroute
17382 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17383 *.saved.domain2.example \
17384 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17387 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17389 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17390 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17391 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17392 the address if the lookup fails.
17395 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17396 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17397 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17398 one way it can be done:
17404 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17405 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17406 return_fail_output = true
17411 driver = manualroute
17413 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17415 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17417 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17419 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17420 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17421 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17423 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
17424 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
17433 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17436 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17437 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17438 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17439 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
17440 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17441 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17442 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17443 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17444 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17445 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17447 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17449 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17450 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17451 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17452 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17453 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17456 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
17457 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17458 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17459 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17460 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17461 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17464 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
17465 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17466 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17467 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17468 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17469 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17470 not set, a value for the gid also.
17472 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17473 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17474 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17475 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17476 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17477 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17481 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
17482 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17483 before running the command.
17486 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17487 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17488 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17492 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17493 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17494 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17495 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17496 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17499 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17502 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17503 &%no_more%& is set.
17505 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17506 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17507 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17508 included in the SMTP response.
17510 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17511 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17512 included in any SMTP response.
17514 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
17516 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17517 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
17519 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17520 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17521 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
17524 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
17525 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17528 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17529 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17531 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17532 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
17533 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
17534 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17536 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
17537 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
17538 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
17539 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
17540 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
17542 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17543 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17544 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17545 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
17546 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17548 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17549 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
17550 variable. For example, this return line
17552 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17554 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17555 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
17556 .ecindex IIDquerou1
17557 .ecindex IIDquerou2
17562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17565 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
17566 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
17567 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
17568 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
17569 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
17570 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17571 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17572 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
17573 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17574 redirected in several different ways:
17577 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17580 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17582 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17584 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17586 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
17588 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
17590 It can be discarded.
17593 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
17594 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17595 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
17596 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
17600 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
17601 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17602 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
17603 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
17604 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
17605 aliases, in a configuration like this:
17609 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17611 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17612 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17613 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17614 cause delivery to be deferred.
17616 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
17617 &_.forward_& files, like this:
17622 file = $home/.forward
17625 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17626 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
17627 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17628 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17633 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
17634 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
17635 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
17636 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
17639 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
17640 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
17641 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
17642 practice the router may not be able to operate.
17644 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
17645 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
17646 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
17647 saves some resources.
17655 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
17656 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17657 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17658 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
17659 can be interpreted in two different ways:
17662 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
17663 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
17664 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
17665 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
17666 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
17667 document is intended for use by end users.
17669 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
17670 described in the next section.
17673 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
17674 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
17675 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
17676 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
17677 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
17681 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
17682 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
17683 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
17684 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
17685 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
17686 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
17687 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
17688 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
17689 commas or newlines.
17690 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
17693 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
17694 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
17695 next newline character is ignored.
17697 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
17698 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
17699 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
17700 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
17703 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17704 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
17705 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
17706 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
17707 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
17708 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
17711 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
17715 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
17716 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
17717 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
17718 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
17719 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
17720 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
17721 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
17722 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
17723 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
17724 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
17725 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
17727 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
17728 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
17729 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
17730 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
17731 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
17733 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
17735 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
17736 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
17737 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
17738 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
17739 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
17742 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
17743 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
17744 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
17745 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
17746 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
17748 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
17749 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
17754 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
17755 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
17758 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17760 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
17761 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
17762 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
17763 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
17764 should really contain
17766 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17768 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
17769 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
17770 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
17774 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
17775 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
17776 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
17779 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
17780 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
17781 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
17782 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
17783 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
17784 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17785 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17787 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
17788 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
17789 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
17790 in double quotes, for example:
17792 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
17794 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
17795 quote just the command. An item such as
17797 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
17799 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
17802 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
17803 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
17804 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
17805 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
17807 /home/world/minbari
17809 is treated as a file name, but
17811 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
17813 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
17814 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
17815 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
17816 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
17818 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17819 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17821 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
17822 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
17823 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
17824 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
17827 .cindex "included address list"
17828 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
17829 If an item is of the form
17831 :include:<path name>
17833 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
17834 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
17835 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
17836 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
17837 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
17838 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
17840 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
17842 It must be given as
17844 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
17847 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
17848 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
17849 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
17850 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
17851 .cindex "black hole"
17852 .cindex "abandoning mail"
17853 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
17854 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
17855 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
17857 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
17858 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
17859 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
17860 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
17864 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
17865 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
17866 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
17867 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
17868 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
17869 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
17870 redirection items of the form
17876 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
17877 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
17878 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
17879 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
17882 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
17884 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
17886 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
17887 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
17889 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
17890 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
17891 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
17893 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
17894 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
17895 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
17896 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
17897 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
17898 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
17899 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
17900 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
17901 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
17904 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
17905 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
17906 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
17907 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
17909 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
17910 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
17911 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
17912 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
17913 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
17915 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
17916 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
17917 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
17918 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
17919 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
17923 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
17924 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
17925 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
17926 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
17927 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
17928 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
17929 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
17933 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
17934 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17935 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
17936 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
17937 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
17938 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
17939 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
17940 aliasing scheme of the type
17942 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
17946 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
17947 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
17948 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
17951 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
17952 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
17954 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
17955 the pipes are distinct.
17959 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
17960 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
17961 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
17962 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
17963 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
17964 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
17965 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
17966 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
17967 can be used to avoid this.
17970 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
17971 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
17972 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
17973 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
17974 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
17975 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
17976 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
17980 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
17982 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
17983 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
17986 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
17987 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
17988 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
17991 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
17992 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
17993 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
17994 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
17997 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
17998 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
17999 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18000 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18001 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18002 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18003 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18005 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18006 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18009 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18010 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18011 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18012 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18013 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18017 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18018 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18019 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18020 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18021 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18022 let ordinary users do.
18026 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18027 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18028 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18029 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18030 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18031 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18033 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18034 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18035 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18036 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18037 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18038 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18040 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18042 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18043 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18044 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18045 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18046 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18047 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18048 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18049 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18052 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18053 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18054 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18055 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18056 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18057 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18058 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18059 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18063 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18064 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18065 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18066 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18067 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18068 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18071 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18072 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18073 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18074 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18075 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18076 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18078 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18079 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18080 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18082 data = #Exim filter\n\
18083 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18085 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18086 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18087 choice into a newline.
18090 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18091 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18092 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18093 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18094 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18097 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18098 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18099 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18100 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18101 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18102 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18103 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18104 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18106 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18107 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18108 runs a check on the containing directory,
18109 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18110 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18111 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18112 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18113 not, the router declines.
18116 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18117 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18118 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18119 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18120 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18121 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18122 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18125 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18126 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18127 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18128 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18129 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18132 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18133 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18137 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18138 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18139 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18144 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18145 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18146 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18147 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18148 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18149 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18150 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18151 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18152 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18155 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18156 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18157 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18158 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18161 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18162 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18163 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18164 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18166 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18167 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18168 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18169 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18170 &_.forward_& files).
18173 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18174 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18175 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18178 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18179 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18180 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18181 of the embedded Perl support.
18184 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18185 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18186 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18189 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18190 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18191 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18194 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18195 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18196 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18197 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18198 &%one_time%& is set.
18201 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18202 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18203 to make use of &%run%& items.
18206 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18207 If this option is true, items of the form
18209 :include:<path name>
18211 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18214 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18215 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18216 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18217 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18218 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18221 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18222 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18223 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18226 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18227 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18228 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18229 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18230 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18235 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18236 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18237 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18238 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18239 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18240 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18241 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18244 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18246 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18247 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18248 file did not exist.
18251 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18253 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18254 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18255 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18257 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18258 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18259 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18260 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18261 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18262 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18263 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18264 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18268 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18269 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18270 redirection list must start with this directory.
18273 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18274 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18275 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18278 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18279 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18280 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18281 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18282 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18283 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18284 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18285 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18286 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18287 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18288 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18289 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18290 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18291 before they subscribed.
18293 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18294 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18295 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18296 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18299 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18300 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18301 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18302 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18304 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18305 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18306 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18308 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18311 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18312 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18313 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18314 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18315 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18319 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18320 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18321 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18322 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18323 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18324 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18325 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18326 See &%check_owner%& above.
18329 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18330 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18331 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18332 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18335 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18336 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18337 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18338 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18339 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18340 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18341 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18344 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18345 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18346 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18347 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18348 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18349 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18350 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18351 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18353 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18354 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18355 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18358 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18359 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18360 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18361 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18362 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18363 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18364 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18365 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18366 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18367 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18370 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18371 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18372 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18373 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18374 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18375 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18378 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18379 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18380 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18381 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18382 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18383 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18386 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
18387 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18388 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18389 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18390 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18393 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18394 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18395 :subaddress part of an address.
18397 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18398 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18399 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18400 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18403 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18404 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18405 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18406 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18407 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18408 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18409 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18413 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18414 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
18415 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18416 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
18417 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18418 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18419 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18420 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18421 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18422 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18423 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18424 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18425 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18426 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18427 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18428 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18430 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18431 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18432 the following routers.
18434 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18435 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18436 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18437 so it is passed to the following routers.
18439 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18440 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18441 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18442 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18444 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18445 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18446 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18447 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18453 file = $home/.forward
18454 file_transport = address_file
18455 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18456 reply_transport = address_reply
18459 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18460 syntax_errors_text = \
18461 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18462 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18463 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18464 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18465 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18466 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18467 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18468 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18469 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18470 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18472 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18473 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18474 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18479 local_part_prefix = real-
18480 transport = local_delivery
18482 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18483 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18485 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18486 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18490 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18491 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18494 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18495 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18496 .ecindex IIDredrou1
18497 .ecindex IIDredrou2
18504 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18507 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18508 "Environment for local transports"
18509 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18510 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
18511 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
18512 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
18513 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18514 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18515 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18517 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18518 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
18519 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18520 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
18522 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18523 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18524 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
18525 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18526 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18530 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
18531 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
18532 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
18533 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
18534 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18535 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18536 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18539 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18540 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18544 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18546 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18547 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18548 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
18549 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18554 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
18555 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18556 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
18557 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
18558 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
18559 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18560 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18561 group (set by the transport). For example:
18564 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18568 transport = group_delivery
18571 # This transport overrides the group
18573 driver = appendfile
18574 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18577 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18578 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
18579 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
18582 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
18583 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
18584 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
18585 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
18586 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
18587 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
18589 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
18590 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
18591 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18592 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
18593 original gid is also used.
18595 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
18596 following that is set is used:
18599 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
18601 A &%group%& setting of the router;
18603 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
18604 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
18606 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
18608 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
18609 the uid is the creator's uid;
18611 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
18614 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
18615 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
18616 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
18617 The first of the following that is set is used:
18620 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
18622 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
18624 A &%user%& setting of the router;
18626 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
18631 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
18632 &%never_users%& list.
18638 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
18639 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18640 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18641 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
18642 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
18643 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
18644 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
18645 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
18646 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
18647 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18650 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18652 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18654 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18656 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18659 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18662 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
18664 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
18668 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
18669 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
18670 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
18674 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
18675 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18676 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18677 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
18678 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
18679 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
18680 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
18681 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
18682 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
18683 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
18684 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
18685 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
18686 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
18687 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
18695 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18696 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18698 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
18699 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
18700 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
18701 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
18702 The following generic options apply to all transports:
18705 .option body_only transports boolean false
18706 .cindex "transport" "body only"
18707 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
18708 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
18709 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
18710 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
18711 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
18712 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
18713 automatically suppress them.
18716 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
18717 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
18718 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
18719 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
18720 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18721 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18724 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
18725 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
18726 deliveries by the transport or for any
18727 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
18728 what you are doing.
18731 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
18732 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18733 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18734 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
18736 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18737 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18738 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18739 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
18740 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
18741 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
18745 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
18746 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
18747 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
18748 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
18749 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
18750 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
18751 safely be resent to other recipients.
18754 .option driver transports string unset
18755 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
18756 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
18759 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
18760 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
18761 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
18762 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
18763 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
18764 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
18765 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
18766 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
18767 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
18768 resent to other recipients.
18771 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
18772 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
18773 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
18774 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
18775 &%user%& (see below).
18778 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
18779 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
18780 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
18781 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
18782 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
18783 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
18784 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18785 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18786 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18790 .option headers_only transports boolean false
18791 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
18792 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
18793 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
18794 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
18795 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
18796 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
18797 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
18800 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
18801 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18802 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
18803 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
18804 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
18805 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
18806 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18807 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18808 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18812 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
18813 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
18814 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
18815 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
18816 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
18817 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
18818 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
18819 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
18822 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
18825 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
18826 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
18827 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
18828 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
18829 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
18830 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
18831 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
18832 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
18833 change envelope recipients at this time.
18836 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
18837 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
18839 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
18840 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
18841 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
18842 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
18843 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
18844 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
18845 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
18849 .option initgroups transports boolean false
18850 .cindex "additional groups"
18851 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18852 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
18853 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
18854 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
18855 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
18858 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
18859 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
18860 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
18861 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
18862 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
18863 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
18864 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
18865 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
18866 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
18867 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
18868 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
18869 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
18870 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
18875 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
18876 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
18877 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
18878 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
18879 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
18880 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
18881 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
18882 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
18885 local_part_prefix = *-
18887 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
18890 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
18892 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
18893 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
18894 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
18895 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
18896 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
18899 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
18900 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18901 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
18902 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
18903 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
18904 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
18905 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
18906 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
18907 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
18909 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
18910 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
18911 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
18912 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
18914 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
18915 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
18916 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
18919 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
18920 .cindex "envelope sender"
18921 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
18922 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
18923 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
18924 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
18925 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
18926 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
18927 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
18928 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
18929 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
18931 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
18932 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
18934 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
18935 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
18936 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
18937 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
18938 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
18939 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
18940 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
18942 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
18943 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
18944 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
18945 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
18946 &%errors_to%& in a router.
18950 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
18951 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
18952 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
18953 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
18954 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
18955 have easy access to it.
18957 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
18958 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
18959 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
18960 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
18961 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
18965 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
18966 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
18969 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
18970 .cindex "shadow transport"
18971 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
18972 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
18973 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
18975 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
18976 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
18977 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
18978 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
18979 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
18980 cause a log line to be written.
18982 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
18983 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
18984 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
18985 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
18986 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
18989 ST=<shadow transport name>
18991 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
18992 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
18993 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
18994 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
18995 headers that some sites insist on.
18998 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
18999 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19000 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19001 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19002 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19003 individual users or via a system filter.
19005 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19006 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19007 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19008 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19009 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19011 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19012 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19013 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19014 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19015 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19016 &(pipe)& transports.
19018 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19019 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19020 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19021 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19022 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19025 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19026 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19027 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19028 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19031 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19032 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19033 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19034 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19035 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19036 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19038 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19039 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19040 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19041 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19042 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19043 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19044 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19045 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19047 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19048 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19049 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19050 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19051 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19052 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19053 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19054 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19055 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19056 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19059 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19060 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19061 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19062 which the message is being sent. For example:
19064 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19065 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19068 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19069 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19070 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19072 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19073 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19074 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19077 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19079 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19080 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19081 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19082 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19083 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19084 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19086 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19087 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19088 arguments. Consider this example:
19090 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19091 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19093 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19094 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19096 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19097 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19101 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19102 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19103 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19104 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19105 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19106 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19107 bounced from a transport filter.
19109 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19110 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19111 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19114 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19115 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19116 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19117 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19118 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19119 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19120 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19121 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19122 becomes a temporary error.
19125 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19126 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19127 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19128 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19129 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19130 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19131 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19134 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19135 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19136 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19138 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19139 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19140 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19141 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19143 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19144 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19145 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19152 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19153 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19155 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19157 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19158 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19159 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19160 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19161 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19162 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19163 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19165 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19166 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19167 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19168 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19169 local transport, for example:
19172 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19173 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19174 recipients saves space.
19176 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19177 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19179 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19180 to a scanner program or
19181 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19185 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19186 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19187 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19189 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19190 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19191 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19192 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19193 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19194 to certain conditions:
19197 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19198 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19199 batching is possible.
19201 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19202 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19203 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19205 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19206 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19207 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19208 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19209 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19212 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19213 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19214 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19218 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19219 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19220 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19221 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19222 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19223 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19224 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19227 escape_string = ".."
19229 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19230 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19231 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19233 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19234 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19235 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19236 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19237 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19238 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19240 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19241 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19242 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19243 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19244 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19245 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19246 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19247 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19248 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19253 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19254 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19256 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19257 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19258 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19259 .cindex "directory creation"
19260 .cindex "creating directories"
19261 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19262 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19263 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19264 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19265 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19266 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19267 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19268 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19269 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19270 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19272 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19273 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19274 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19277 .cindex "quota" "system"
19278 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19279 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19280 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19282 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19283 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19284 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19285 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19287 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19288 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19291 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19292 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19293 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19294 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19299 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19300 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19301 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19302 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19303 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19305 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19306 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19307 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19308 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19309 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19310 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19311 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19312 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19313 operation. There are two cases:
19316 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19317 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19318 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19319 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19320 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19321 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19322 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19324 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19325 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19326 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19330 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19331 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19332 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19333 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19338 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19340 require "fileinto";
19341 fileinto "folder23";
19343 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19344 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19345 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19346 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19347 way of handling this requirement:
19349 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19350 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19351 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19353 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19357 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19358 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19359 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19361 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19362 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19363 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19364 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19365 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19366 path to the transport.
19368 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19369 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19374 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19375 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19379 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19380 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19381 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19382 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19383 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19384 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19385 delivery is deferred.
19388 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19389 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19390 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19391 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19392 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19393 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19394 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19395 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19398 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19399 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19400 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19401 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19405 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19406 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19409 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
19410 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19411 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19412 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19413 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19416 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19417 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19418 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19419 process is running.
19422 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19423 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19424 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19425 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19426 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19427 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19428 contains is significant.
19430 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19431 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19432 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19433 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19434 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19436 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19437 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19438 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19439 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19440 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19441 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19443 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19444 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19445 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19446 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19448 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19449 .cindex "directory creation"
19450 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19451 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19452 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19454 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19455 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19456 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19457 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19458 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19462 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19463 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19464 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19465 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19466 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19469 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19470 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19471 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19472 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19473 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19474 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19475 &%file_must_exist%&.
19478 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19479 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19480 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19481 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19483 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19484 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19485 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19486 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19487 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19490 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19492 .vindex "&$inode$&"
19493 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19494 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19495 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19497 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19499 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19500 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19504 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19505 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19506 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19509 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19510 See &%check_string%& above.
19513 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
19514 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
19515 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
19516 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
19517 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19518 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
19521 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19522 .cindex "locking files"
19523 .cindex "lock files"
19524 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19525 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19527 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19528 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19531 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19532 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19535 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
19536 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19537 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
19538 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
19539 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
19540 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19544 .option file_format appendfile string unset
19545 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
19546 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19547 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19548 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19549 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19550 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19551 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19552 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
19555 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19556 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19558 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
19559 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19560 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
19561 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19562 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19563 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19564 delivery is deferred.
19567 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
19568 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
19569 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
19570 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
19573 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
19574 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19575 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
19576 .cindex "locking files"
19577 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
19578 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19579 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
19580 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19581 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19582 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19583 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19584 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19586 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19587 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19588 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19589 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19591 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19592 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19595 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19597 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19598 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19599 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
19601 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19602 local deliveries because of errors of the form
19604 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19607 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
19608 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
19609 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
19610 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
19613 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
19614 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19615 for details of locking.
19618 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
19619 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19620 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19623 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19624 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19625 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
19628 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
19629 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19630 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
19631 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19632 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19635 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
19636 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19637 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19638 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19639 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19640 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
19641 external source that maintains the data.
19644 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
19645 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19646 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19647 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19648 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
19649 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
19650 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
19651 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
19655 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
19656 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
19657 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
19658 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
19659 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
19660 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
19661 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
19662 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
19663 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
19664 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19667 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
19668 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
19669 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
19670 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
19671 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
19672 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
19673 calculation. The default value is:
19675 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
19677 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
19678 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
19680 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
19682 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
19684 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
19685 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
19686 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
19687 directly into that directory.
19690 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
19691 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
19692 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19695 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
19696 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
19697 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19700 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile boolean false
19701 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
19702 Setting this option true enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
19703 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
19704 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
19705 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
19706 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19708 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
19709 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
19710 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
19711 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
19712 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
19713 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
19714 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
19715 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
19716 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
19717 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
19720 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
19721 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
19722 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
19723 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
19724 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
19725 below for further details.
19728 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
19729 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19730 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19733 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
19734 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19735 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19738 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
19739 .cindex "locking files"
19740 .cindex "file" "locking"
19741 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
19742 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
19743 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19744 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
19745 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
19746 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
19747 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
19749 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
19750 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
19751 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
19758 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
19759 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
19760 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
19761 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
19762 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
19763 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
19764 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
19765 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
19767 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
19768 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
19769 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
19770 append messages to it.
19773 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19774 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19775 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
19776 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19777 in which case it is:
19779 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
19780 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
19782 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19783 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
19785 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19786 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
19787 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19788 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
19793 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19794 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
19796 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19797 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
19798 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
19799 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
19800 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
19801 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
19802 value, and this option is ignored.
19805 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
19806 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
19807 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
19808 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
19809 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
19812 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
19813 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
19814 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
19815 on users about incoming mail.
19818 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
19819 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
19820 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
19821 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
19822 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
19823 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
19824 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
19825 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
19826 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
19828 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
19829 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
19830 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
19832 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
19833 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
19834 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
19835 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
19836 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
19837 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
19839 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
19840 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
19841 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
19842 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
19845 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
19847 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
19848 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
19849 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
19850 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
19851 system quota failures.
19853 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
19854 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
19855 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
19856 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
19857 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
19858 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
19859 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
19860 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
19861 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
19862 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
19865 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
19866 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
19867 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
19868 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
19869 delivery directory.
19872 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
19873 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
19874 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
19875 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
19876 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
19880 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
19881 See &%quota%& above.
19884 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
19885 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
19886 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
19887 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
19888 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
19889 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
19890 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
19892 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
19893 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
19894 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
19895 the file length to the file name. For example:
19897 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
19898 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
19900 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
19901 number of lines in the message.
19903 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
19904 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
19905 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
19909 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
19910 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
19911 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
19913 quota_warn_message = "\
19914 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
19915 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
19916 This message is automatically created \
19917 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
19918 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
19919 a warning threshold that is\n\
19920 set by the system administrator.\n"
19924 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
19925 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
19926 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
19927 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19928 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
19929 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
19930 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
19931 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
19932 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
19936 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
19938 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
19939 percent sign is ignored.
19941 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
19942 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
19943 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
19944 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
19945 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
19946 &'From:'& line, the default is:
19948 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
19950 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
19951 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
19954 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
19955 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
19959 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
19960 .cindex "envelope sender"
19961 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
19962 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
19963 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
19964 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
19965 for details of batch SMTP.
19968 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
19969 .cindex "carriage return"
19971 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
19972 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
19973 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
19974 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
19976 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
19977 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
19978 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
19979 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
19980 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
19981 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
19984 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
19985 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
19986 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
19987 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
19988 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
19989 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
19992 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
19993 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
19994 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
19995 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
19996 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
19998 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
19999 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20000 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20001 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20003 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20004 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20005 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20006 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20007 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20010 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20011 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20014 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20015 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20016 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20017 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20018 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20019 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20020 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20022 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20023 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20024 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20025 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20028 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20029 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20030 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20033 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20034 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20035 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20036 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20037 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20038 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20039 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20040 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20041 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20043 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20044 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20045 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20046 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20051 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20052 .cindex "appending to a file"
20053 .cindex "file" "appending"
20054 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20057 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20061 .cindex "directory creation"
20062 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20063 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20064 &%directory_mode%& option.
20067 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20068 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20072 .cindex "file" "locking"
20073 .cindex "locking files"
20074 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20075 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20076 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20079 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20080 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20081 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20083 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20085 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20086 Unlink the hitching post name.
20088 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20089 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20090 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20091 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20093 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20094 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20095 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20096 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20097 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20098 it before trying again.
20102 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20103 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20104 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20107 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20108 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20109 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20110 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20111 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20112 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20113 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20114 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20115 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20119 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20120 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20121 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20122 delivery is deferred.
20125 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20126 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20127 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20131 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20132 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20133 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20136 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20137 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20138 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20141 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20142 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20143 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20144 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20145 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20146 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20147 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20148 that prevents link following.
20151 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20152 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20153 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20154 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20155 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20158 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20161 .cindex "file" "locking"
20162 .cindex "locking files"
20163 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20164 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20165 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20166 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20167 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20169 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20171 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20172 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20173 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20175 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20176 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20177 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20179 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20180 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20181 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20182 delivery is deferred.
20184 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20185 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20186 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20187 immediately. It retries up to
20189 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20191 times (rounded up).
20194 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20195 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20198 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20199 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20200 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20201 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20202 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20203 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20204 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20205 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20206 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20207 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20209 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20210 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20211 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20212 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20213 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20214 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20215 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20217 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20218 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20219 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20220 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20223 .cindex "maildir format"
20224 .cindex "mailstore format"
20225 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20226 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20227 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20228 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20229 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20231 .cindex "directory creation"
20232 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20233 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20234 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20235 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20236 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20237 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20242 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20243 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20244 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20245 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20246 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20247 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20248 &_new_& subdirectory.
20250 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20251 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20252 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20253 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20254 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20255 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20256 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20258 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20259 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20260 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20261 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20262 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20263 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20264 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20265 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20267 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20268 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20269 folders. Consider this example:
20271 maildir_format = true
20272 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20273 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20274 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20275 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20277 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20278 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20279 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20280 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20281 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20282 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20284 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20285 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20286 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20287 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20288 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20290 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20291 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20292 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20294 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20295 .cindex "maildir++"
20296 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20297 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20298 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20299 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20300 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20301 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20302 amount of space used.
20304 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20305 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20306 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20307 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20308 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20309 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20314 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20315 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20316 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20317 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20318 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20319 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20321 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20322 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20323 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20324 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20325 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20326 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20327 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20328 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20329 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20334 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20335 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20336 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20337 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20338 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20339 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20340 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20341 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20342 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20344 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20345 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20346 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20347 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20348 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20349 need to know the quota.
20351 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20352 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20354 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20355 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20356 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20360 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20361 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20362 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20363 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20364 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20365 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20366 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20367 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20369 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20370 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20371 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20372 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20373 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20374 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20376 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20377 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20378 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20379 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20380 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20381 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20383 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20384 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20385 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20386 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20389 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20390 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20391 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20392 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20393 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20395 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20397 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20398 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20399 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20400 .ecindex IIDapptra1
20401 .ecindex IIDapptra2
20408 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20409 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20411 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20412 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20413 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20414 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20415 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20416 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20417 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20418 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20420 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20421 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20422 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20423 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20424 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20427 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20428 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20429 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20430 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20431 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20433 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20434 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20435 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20436 transport is run as a consequence of a
20438 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20439 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20440 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20441 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20442 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20443 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20445 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20446 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20447 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20448 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20450 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20451 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20452 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20453 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20454 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20455 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20456 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20458 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20459 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20460 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20461 the transport defers.
20462 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20463 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20465 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20466 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20467 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20468 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20470 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20471 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20472 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20473 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20474 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20475 problems. They are just discarded.
20479 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20480 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20482 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20483 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20484 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20487 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20488 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20489 when the message is specified by the transport.
20492 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
20493 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20494 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20495 string comes first.
20498 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
20499 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
20500 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20503 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
20504 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
20505 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20508 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
20509 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
20510 specified by the transport.
20513 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
20514 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
20515 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
20516 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20519 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
20520 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20521 the message is specified by the transport.
20524 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
20525 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
20529 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
20530 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20531 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20532 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
20533 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
20537 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
20538 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
20539 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
20540 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
20542 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
20543 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
20544 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
20545 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
20546 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
20547 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
20548 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
20551 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
20552 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
20553 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
20554 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
20555 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
20557 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
20558 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
20559 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
20560 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
20561 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
20562 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
20565 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
20566 See &%once%& above.
20569 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
20570 See &%once%& above.
20571 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20574 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
20575 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
20576 specified by the transport.
20579 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
20580 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20581 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
20582 configuration option.
20585 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
20586 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
20587 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
20588 automatic responses. For example:
20590 subject = Re: $h_subject:
20592 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20593 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20594 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20595 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20600 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
20601 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20602 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
20603 the text comes first.
20606 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
20607 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
20608 when the message is specified by the transport.
20609 .ecindex IIDauttra1
20610 .ecindex IIDauttra2
20615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20616 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20618 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
20619 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
20620 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
20621 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
20622 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
20623 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
20625 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
20626 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
20627 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
20628 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
20629 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
20630 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
20634 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
20635 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
20636 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
20639 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
20640 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20643 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
20644 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20645 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
20646 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
20647 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20650 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
20651 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
20652 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
20653 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
20654 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
20655 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
20658 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
20659 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
20660 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
20661 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
20662 in its response to the LHLO command.
20664 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
20665 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
20666 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
20667 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
20670 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
20671 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
20672 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
20673 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
20678 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
20682 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
20683 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
20687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20690 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
20691 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
20692 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
20693 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
20694 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
20695 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
20696 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
20697 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
20701 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20702 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
20703 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
20704 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
20705 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
20707 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20708 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
20709 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
20710 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
20711 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
20712 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
20713 that are routed to the transport.
20715 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20716 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
20717 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
20718 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
20719 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
20720 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
20721 the local part that was redirected.
20725 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
20726 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
20727 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
20729 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
20730 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
20731 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
20732 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
20733 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
20734 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
20735 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
20738 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
20739 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
20740 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
20741 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
20742 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
20747 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
20748 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
20749 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
20750 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
20751 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
20752 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
20753 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
20754 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
20755 &"local delivery failed"&.
20757 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
20758 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
20759 value is the return code minus 128.
20761 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
20762 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
20763 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
20764 a non-existent command may be the problem.
20766 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
20767 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
20768 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
20769 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
20770 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
20771 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
20772 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
20777 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
20778 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
20779 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
20780 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
20781 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
20784 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
20785 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
20786 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
20787 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
20789 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
20790 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
20791 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
20792 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
20793 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
20795 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
20797 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
20798 arguments. You have to write
20800 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
20802 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
20803 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
20804 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
20805 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
20806 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
20807 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
20810 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
20813 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20814 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20815 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20816 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
20817 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
20818 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
20819 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
20820 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
20821 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
20822 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
20824 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
20825 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
20826 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
20827 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
20828 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
20829 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
20830 control what is done with it.
20832 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
20833 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
20834 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
20835 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
20836 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
20837 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
20838 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
20839 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
20840 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
20841 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
20842 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
20846 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
20847 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20848 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
20849 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
20850 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
20851 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
20854 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
20855 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
20856 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
20857 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
20858 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
20859 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
20860 &`LOGNAME `& see below
20861 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
20862 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
20863 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
20864 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
20865 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
20866 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
20867 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
20868 &`USER `& see below
20870 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
20871 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
20872 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
20873 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
20874 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
20875 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
20876 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
20879 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
20880 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
20881 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
20885 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
20886 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
20887 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
20888 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
20891 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
20892 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
20896 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
20897 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
20898 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20899 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
20900 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
20901 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
20902 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
20903 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
20904 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
20905 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
20906 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
20909 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
20911 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
20912 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
20913 &%use_shell%& is set.
20916 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
20917 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20920 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
20921 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20922 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20925 .option check_string pipe string unset
20926 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
20927 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
20928 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
20929 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
20930 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
20931 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
20932 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
20936 .option command pipe string&!! unset
20937 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
20938 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
20939 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
20940 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
20941 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
20942 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
20945 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
20946 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20947 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
20948 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
20949 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
20950 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20951 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
20954 .option escape_string pipe string unset
20955 See &%check_string%& above.
20958 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
20959 .cindex "exec failure"
20960 .cindex "failure of exec"
20961 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
20962 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
20963 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
20964 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
20965 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
20968 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
20969 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
20970 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
20971 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
20972 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
20973 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
20975 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
20976 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
20978 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
20979 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
20980 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
20981 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
20982 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
20985 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
20986 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
20987 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
20988 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
20989 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
20990 Only one of them may be set.
20994 .option log_output pipe boolean false
20995 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
20996 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
20997 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21001 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21002 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21003 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21004 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21005 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21006 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21007 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21008 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21011 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21012 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21013 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21016 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21020 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21021 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21022 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21023 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21024 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21029 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21030 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21033 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21034 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21035 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21036 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21040 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21041 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21044 .option path pipe string "see below"
21045 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21046 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21050 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21051 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21052 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21055 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21056 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21057 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21058 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21059 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21060 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21061 accept the message is used.
21064 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21065 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21066 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21067 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21068 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21069 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21072 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21073 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21074 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21075 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21076 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21077 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21078 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21082 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21083 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21084 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21085 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21086 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21087 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21088 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21089 of them may be set.
21093 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21094 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21095 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21096 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21097 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21098 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21099 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21100 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21101 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21102 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21103 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21104 and 73, respectively.
21107 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21108 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21109 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21110 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21111 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21112 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21113 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21115 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21116 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21117 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21118 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21119 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21120 delivery to be deferred.
21122 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21123 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21126 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21127 .cindex "envelope sender"
21128 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21129 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21130 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21131 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21132 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21134 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21135 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21136 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21137 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21138 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21139 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21143 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21144 .cindex "carriage return"
21146 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21147 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21148 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21149 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21151 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21152 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21153 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21154 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21155 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21158 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21159 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21160 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21161 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21162 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21163 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21164 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21165 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21166 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21171 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21172 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21173 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21174 .cindex "external local delivery"
21175 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21176 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21177 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21178 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21179 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21180 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21181 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21182 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21183 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21184 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21189 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21193 check_string = "From "
21194 escape_string = ">From "
21202 transport = procmail_pipe
21204 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21205 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21206 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21207 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21208 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21209 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21211 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21215 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21216 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21219 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21220 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21223 local_delivery_cyrus:
21225 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21226 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21238 local_part_suffix = .*
21239 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21241 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21242 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21244 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21245 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21248 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21249 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21251 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21252 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21253 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21254 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21255 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21256 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21257 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21258 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21261 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21262 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21266 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21267 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21268 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21269 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21270 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21271 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21272 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21274 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21275 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21276 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21277 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21278 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21279 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21284 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21285 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21286 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21290 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21292 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21293 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21294 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21295 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21296 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21297 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21298 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21299 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21302 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21303 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21304 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21305 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
21306 and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
21307 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21308 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
21309 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21310 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21311 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21312 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21315 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21316 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21317 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21320 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21321 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21322 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21323 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21324 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21325 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21326 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21327 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21329 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21330 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
21331 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21332 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21333 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21334 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21335 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21336 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21337 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21340 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21342 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21343 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21344 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21345 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21346 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21349 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21350 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21351 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21352 particular connection.
21354 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21355 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21356 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21357 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21359 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21360 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21361 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21363 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21365 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21366 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21368 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21369 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21373 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21374 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21375 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21376 authenticated as a client.
21379 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21380 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21381 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21382 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21385 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21386 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21387 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21388 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21389 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21390 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21391 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21394 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21395 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21396 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21397 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21398 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21399 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21400 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21404 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21405 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21406 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21407 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21410 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21411 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21412 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21415 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21416 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21417 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21418 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21419 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21420 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21422 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21423 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21424 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21425 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21426 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21427 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21428 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21429 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21433 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21434 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21435 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21436 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21437 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21440 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21441 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21442 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21443 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21448 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21449 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21450 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21451 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21452 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21453 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21454 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21455 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21457 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21458 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21459 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21460 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21461 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21462 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21464 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21465 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21466 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21467 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21468 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21470 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21471 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21472 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
21473 copy of the message is sent.
21475 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21476 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
21477 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21478 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
21482 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
21483 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21484 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
21487 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
21488 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
21489 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
21490 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
21491 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21492 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
21494 .option gnutls_require_kx smtp string unset
21495 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21496 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21498 .option gnutls_require_mac smtp string unset
21499 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21500 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21502 .option gnutls_require_protocols smtp string unset
21503 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21504 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21507 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
21508 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
21509 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
21510 implementations of TLS.
21513 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
21514 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
21515 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
21516 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
21517 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
21518 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
21519 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
21524 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
21525 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
21526 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
21527 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
21528 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
21529 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
21530 interface address, you could use this:
21532 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
21533 {$primary_hostname}}
21535 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
21538 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
21539 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
21540 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
21541 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
21542 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
21543 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
21545 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
21546 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
21547 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
21548 &%hosts_override%& is set.
21550 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21551 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
21552 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
21553 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21554 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21555 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
21556 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
21558 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
21559 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
21560 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
21561 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
21562 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
21563 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
21564 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
21567 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21568 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
21571 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
21572 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
21573 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
21574 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
21575 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21576 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21577 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21578 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21579 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21580 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21583 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
21584 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21585 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
21586 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
21589 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21590 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
21591 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21592 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21595 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
21596 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21597 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
21598 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
21599 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
21600 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21601 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
21602 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
21605 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
21606 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
21607 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
21612 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21613 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
21614 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21615 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
21616 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
21617 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
21618 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
21619 explanation of when this might be needed.
21622 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
21623 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
21624 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
21625 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
21626 &%fallback_hosts%&.
21629 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
21630 .cindex "randomized host list"
21631 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
21632 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
21633 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
21634 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
21635 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
21636 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
21637 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
21638 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
21640 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
21641 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
21642 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
21643 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21645 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21647 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21648 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21649 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
21651 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21652 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
21653 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
21654 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
21655 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
21656 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
21657 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
21658 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
21659 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21662 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21663 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
21664 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21665 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21666 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
21667 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
21669 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21670 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
21671 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
21672 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
21673 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
21674 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
21675 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21677 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
21678 .cindex "bind IP address"
21679 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
21681 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21682 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
21683 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
21684 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
21685 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
21686 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
21687 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
21688 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
21691 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
21692 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
21693 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
21694 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
21695 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
21696 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
21698 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
21700 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
21701 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
21702 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
21703 interface to use if the host has more than one.
21706 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
21707 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
21708 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
21709 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
21710 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
21711 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
21712 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
21713 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
21714 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
21715 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
21719 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
21720 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21721 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
21722 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
21723 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
21725 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
21726 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
21727 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
21728 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
21729 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
21733 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
21734 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21735 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
21736 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
21737 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
21738 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
21739 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
21740 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
21743 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
21744 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
21745 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
21746 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
21747 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
21748 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
21749 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
21750 variable that contains an outgoing port.
21752 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
21753 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
21754 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
21755 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
21760 .option protocol smtp string smtp
21761 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
21762 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
21763 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
21764 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
21765 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
21766 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
21769 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
21770 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
21771 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
21772 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
21773 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
21774 addresses is not affected.
21776 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
21777 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
21778 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
21779 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
21780 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
21784 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
21785 .cindex "serializing connections"
21786 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
21787 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
21788 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
21789 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
21790 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
21791 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
21792 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
21794 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
21795 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
21796 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
21797 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
21798 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21799 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21801 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
21802 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21803 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21804 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21805 are used for ETRN serialization.
21808 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
21809 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21810 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
21811 .cindex "size" "of message"
21812 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21813 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21814 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
21815 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
21816 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
21817 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
21818 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
21819 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
21821 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
21822 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
21825 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
21826 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
21827 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
21829 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21830 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21831 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
21832 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
21833 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
21836 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
21837 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
21838 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
21839 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
21843 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
21844 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
21845 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
21846 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
21847 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
21850 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
21851 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
21853 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21854 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21855 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
21856 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
21857 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21858 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
21859 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
21860 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21863 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
21864 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
21865 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
21867 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21868 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
21869 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
21870 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
21871 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21872 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
21873 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
21874 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
21875 ciphers is a preference order.
21879 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
21880 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
21881 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
21882 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
21883 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
21884 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
21885 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
21886 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
21887 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21888 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
21892 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
21893 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
21894 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
21896 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21897 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
21898 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
21899 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
21900 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
21901 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
21902 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
21903 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21904 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21909 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
21911 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21912 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
21913 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
21914 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
21915 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
21918 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
21919 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
21920 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
21921 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
21924 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
21925 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
21926 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
21928 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
21929 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
21930 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
21931 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
21932 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
21934 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
21935 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
21936 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
21937 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
21938 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
21939 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
21940 see below for an exception).
21942 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
21943 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
21944 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
21945 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
21946 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
21948 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
21949 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
21950 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
21951 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
21952 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
21953 reached their retry times.
21955 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
21956 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
21957 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
21958 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
21959 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
21960 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
21961 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
21962 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
21963 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
21964 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
21967 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
21968 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
21969 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
21970 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
21971 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
21972 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
21974 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
21975 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
21976 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
21977 possible IP addresses have been tried.
21978 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
21979 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
21985 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21986 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21988 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
21989 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
21990 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
21991 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
21992 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
21993 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
21995 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
21996 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
21997 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
21998 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
21999 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22000 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22001 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22003 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22004 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22005 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22006 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22009 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22010 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22011 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22012 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22014 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22015 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22016 facility; you do not have to use it.
22018 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22019 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22020 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22021 address to which it applies.
22023 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22024 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22025 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22026 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22027 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22028 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22031 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22032 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22033 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22034 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22037 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22038 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22039 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22040 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22041 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22044 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22045 illustrated by these examples:
22048 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22049 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22050 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22051 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22053 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22054 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22059 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22060 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22061 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22062 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22063 message's processing.
22065 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22066 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22067 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22068 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22069 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22070 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22071 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22072 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22073 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22075 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22076 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22077 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22078 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22079 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22080 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22081 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22082 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22083 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22084 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22086 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22087 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22088 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22089 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22090 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22091 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22093 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22094 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22095 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22097 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22098 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22099 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22100 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22101 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22102 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22103 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22104 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22105 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22107 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22108 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22114 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22115 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22116 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22117 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22118 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22119 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22120 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22121 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22122 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22123 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22125 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22127 might produce the output
22129 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22130 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22131 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22132 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22133 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22134 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22135 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22136 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22138 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22139 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22140 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22141 set for a particular transport.
22144 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22145 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22146 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22149 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22151 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22152 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22153 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22154 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22156 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22157 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22158 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22159 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22162 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22163 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22164 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22166 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22167 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22168 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22169 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22170 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22171 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22172 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22174 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22175 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22176 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22177 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22178 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22182 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22183 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22186 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22187 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22188 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22189 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22190 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22191 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22192 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22193 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22194 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22196 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22197 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22198 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22200 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22201 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22202 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22203 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22204 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22205 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22206 of pattern they are set as follows:
22209 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22210 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22211 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22214 *queen@*.fict.example
22216 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22218 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22222 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22223 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22226 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22227 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22228 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22229 rewriting rule of the form
22231 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22233 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22239 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22240 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22241 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22242 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22243 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22247 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22248 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22249 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22250 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22251 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22253 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22255 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22258 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22259 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22260 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22261 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22262 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22263 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22264 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22265 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22266 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22267 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22268 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22269 entry written to the panic log.
22273 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22274 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22277 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22280 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22282 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22285 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22286 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22290 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22292 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22293 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22294 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22295 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22296 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22297 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22299 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22300 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22301 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22302 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22303 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22304 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22305 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22306 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22307 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22308 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22310 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22311 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22312 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22314 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22315 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22318 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22319 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22320 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22321 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22322 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22323 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22324 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22325 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22326 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22328 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22329 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22330 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22331 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22332 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22333 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22334 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22335 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22338 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22339 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22340 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22341 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22344 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22345 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22346 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22348 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22349 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22350 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22351 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22353 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22354 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22355 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22357 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22358 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22359 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22360 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22362 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22366 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22369 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22370 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22371 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22372 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22373 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22374 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22375 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22376 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22378 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22379 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22383 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22384 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22386 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22387 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22388 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22390 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22391 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22392 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22393 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22394 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22395 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22396 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22397 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22399 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22400 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22402 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22404 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22405 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22407 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22408 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22409 messages that originate outside the local host:
22411 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22412 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22414 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22417 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22418 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22419 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22420 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22421 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22422 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22423 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22424 components. For example, the rule
22426 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22428 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22429 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22430 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22431 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22432 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22433 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22434 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22441 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22442 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22444 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22445 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22446 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22447 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22448 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22449 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22450 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22451 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22452 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22453 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22454 address, domain and error.
22456 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22457 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22458 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22459 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22460 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22461 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
22462 log selector is set, the message
22463 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
22464 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22465 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
22466 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22468 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22469 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22470 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22471 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
22472 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22473 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22474 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22475 domain are maintained independently.
22477 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22478 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22479 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22480 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22481 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22482 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22483 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22484 the local address is reached.
22486 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
22487 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
22488 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
22489 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
22490 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
22492 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
22493 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
22494 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
22495 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
22496 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
22497 messages that it should now be retaining.
22501 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
22502 .cindex "retry" "rules"
22503 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22504 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22505 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22506 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
22507 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22508 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22509 message's sender, respectively.
22512 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22513 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
22514 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
22515 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
22516 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
22517 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
22520 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22522 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
22525 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22527 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
22528 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22531 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
22532 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22533 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22534 expressions work in address lists.
22536 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
22537 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
22541 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
22542 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22543 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22544 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
22545 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22546 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
22547 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22548 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
22549 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
22551 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22552 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22553 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22554 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22557 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
22558 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
22559 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
22560 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
22561 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
22562 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
22563 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
22564 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
22565 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
22566 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
22571 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
22573 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
22574 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
22575 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
22576 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
22577 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
22578 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
22580 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22584 and the retry rules are
22586 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22587 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22589 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
22590 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
22591 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
22592 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
22593 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
22594 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
22596 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
22597 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
22598 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
22599 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
22601 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
22602 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
22603 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
22605 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
22607 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
22608 textual form of the IP address.
22610 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
22611 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
22612 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
22613 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
22616 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
22617 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
22618 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
22620 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
22621 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
22622 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
22624 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
22625 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
22627 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
22628 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
22631 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
22632 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
22633 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
22634 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
22635 retry rule of this form:
22637 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
22639 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
22640 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
22643 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
22644 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
22645 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
22646 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
22648 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
22649 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
22651 .vitem &%refused_A%&
22652 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
22655 A connection was refused.
22657 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
22658 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
22660 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
22661 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
22663 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
22664 A connection attempt timed out.
22666 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
22667 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
22668 obtained from an MX record.
22670 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
22671 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
22672 obtained from an MX record.
22675 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
22677 .vitem &%tls_required%&
22678 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
22679 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
22680 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
22683 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22686 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
22687 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
22688 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
22689 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22690 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
22691 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
22695 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
22696 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
22697 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
22698 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
22699 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
22703 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
22704 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
22705 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
22707 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
22708 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
22709 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
22710 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
22711 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
22712 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
22713 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
22715 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
22716 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
22719 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
22720 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
22721 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
22726 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
22727 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
22728 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
22729 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
22730 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
22733 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
22735 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
22737 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
22739 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
22740 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
22743 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
22745 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
22746 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
22747 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
22748 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
22749 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
22751 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
22752 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
22754 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
22756 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
22757 list is never matched.
22763 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
22764 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
22765 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
22766 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
22768 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
22770 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
22771 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
22772 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
22773 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
22774 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
22776 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
22777 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
22778 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
22779 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
22780 The available algorithms are:
22783 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
22786 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
22787 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
22788 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
22790 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
22791 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
22792 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
22793 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
22794 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
22795 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
22796 queue processing times.
22799 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
22800 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
22801 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
22802 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
22803 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
22804 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
22805 interval is found. The main configuration variable
22806 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
22807 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
22808 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
22809 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
22810 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
22812 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
22813 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
22814 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
22815 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
22816 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
22817 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
22820 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
22821 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
22822 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
22823 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
22824 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
22825 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
22826 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
22827 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
22828 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
22829 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
22830 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
22831 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
22833 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
22834 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
22835 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
22836 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
22837 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
22838 deliveries that have been deferred.
22841 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
22842 Here are some example retry rules:
22844 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
22845 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
22846 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
22847 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22848 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
22849 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
22851 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
22852 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
22853 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
22854 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
22855 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
22856 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
22857 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
22860 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
22861 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
22862 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
22863 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
22864 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
22866 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
22867 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
22868 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
22869 were not obtained from an MX record.
22871 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
22872 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
22873 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
22874 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
22875 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
22879 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
22880 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
22881 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
22882 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
22883 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
22884 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
22885 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
22886 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
22887 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
22888 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
22889 failing for the first time.
22891 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
22892 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
22893 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
22894 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
22896 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
22897 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
22898 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
22903 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
22904 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
22905 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
22906 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
22907 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
22908 default retry rule:
22910 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
22912 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
22913 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
22914 failure for the recipient address that counts.
22916 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
22917 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
22918 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
22919 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
22920 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
22922 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
22923 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
22924 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
22926 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
22927 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
22928 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
22929 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
22930 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
22931 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
22932 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
22933 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
22935 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
22936 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
22937 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
22938 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
22939 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
22942 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22943 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
22944 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22945 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
22946 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
22947 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
22948 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
22949 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
22950 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
22953 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
22954 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
22955 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
22956 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
22957 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
22958 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
22959 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
22960 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
22963 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
22964 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
22965 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
22966 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
22967 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
22968 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
22969 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
22970 time out the address.
22972 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
22973 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
22974 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
22975 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
22976 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
22977 considered immediately.
22978 .ecindex IIDretconf1
22979 .ecindex IIDregconf2
22986 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22987 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22989 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
22990 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
22991 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
22992 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
22993 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
22994 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
22995 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
22996 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
22997 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23000 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23001 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23004 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23005 the client's EHLO command.
23007 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23008 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23010 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23011 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23012 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23013 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23014 with the AUTH command.
23016 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23018 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23019 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23020 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23023 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23024 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23025 unauthenticated connection.
23028 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23029 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23030 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23031 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23033 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23034 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23035 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23036 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
23037 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23038 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23039 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23040 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23045 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23046 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23047 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23048 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23049 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23050 included by setting
23053 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23057 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23058 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23059 the Cyrus SASL authentication library. The third can be configured to support
23060 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23061 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The fourth authenticator
23062 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23064 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23065 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23066 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23067 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23068 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23069 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23070 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23072 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23073 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23074 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23075 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23076 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23077 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23081 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23082 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23084 client_secret = secret2
23086 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23087 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23089 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23090 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23091 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23096 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23097 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23098 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23100 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23101 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23102 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23103 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23104 encrypted by a setting such as:
23106 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23108 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23109 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23110 cipher used for the delivery.)
23113 .option driver authenticators string unset
23114 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23115 authenticators is to be used.
23118 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23119 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23120 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23121 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23122 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23123 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23126 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23127 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23128 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23129 mechanism is not advertised.
23130 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23131 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23132 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23135 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23136 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23137 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23140 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23141 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23142 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23143 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23144 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23145 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23146 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23147 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23148 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23152 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23153 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23154 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23155 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23156 out the values of variables.
23157 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23158 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23161 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23162 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23163 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23164 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23165 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23166 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23167 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23168 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23169 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23172 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23173 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23174 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23175 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23176 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23177 remembered for later use.
23178 How it is used is described in the following section.
23184 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23185 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23186 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23187 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23188 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23192 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23193 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23195 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23197 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23198 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23199 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23200 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23201 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23202 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23203 given for the MAIL command.
23205 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23206 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23209 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23210 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23211 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23212 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23213 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23214 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23215 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23220 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23221 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23222 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23223 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23225 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23226 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23227 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23228 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23229 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23234 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23235 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23236 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23237 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23241 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23243 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23244 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23247 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23248 the mechanisms are advertised.
23250 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23251 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23252 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23253 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23254 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23255 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23256 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23258 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23260 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23262 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23263 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23264 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23267 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23269 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23270 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23271 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23273 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23274 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23275 command. This is the case if
23278 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23280 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23282 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23283 server authenticators.
23287 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23288 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23289 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23291 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23292 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23293 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23294 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23295 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23296 rejected with a 504 error.
23298 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23299 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23300 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23301 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23302 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23303 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23304 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23305 no successful authentication.
23310 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23311 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23312 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23313 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23314 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23315 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23316 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23320 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23322 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23323 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23324 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23325 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23326 command line to run this script on such data might be
23328 encode '\0user\0password'
23330 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23331 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23332 whose code value is zero.
23334 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23335 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23336 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23337 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23339 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23340 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23341 example, a command such as
23343 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23345 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23347 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23348 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23350 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23352 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23353 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23354 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23355 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23359 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23360 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23361 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23362 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23363 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23364 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23367 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23368 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23369 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23370 of the authenticator.
23373 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23374 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23375 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23376 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23377 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23378 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23379 delivery to be deferred.
23381 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23382 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23383 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23386 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23387 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23388 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23389 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23390 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23391 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23392 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23393 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23394 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23397 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23398 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23399 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23400 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23401 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23402 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23403 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23404 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23405 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23406 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23407 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23408 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
23409 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
23416 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23419 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
23420 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
23421 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
23422 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23423 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23424 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23425 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
23426 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
23427 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
23428 connections as you do for login accounts.
23430 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
23431 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
23432 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
23434 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23435 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
23436 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
23438 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
23439 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23440 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23443 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
23444 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23445 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23446 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
23447 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23448 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
23449 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23451 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
23452 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
23453 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
23454 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
23455 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
23456 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
23457 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
23459 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
23460 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
23461 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
23462 string expansions that also use them for other things.
23464 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
23465 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
23466 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23468 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23469 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23470 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
23471 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
23472 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
23473 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23474 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
23475 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
23476 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
23477 string as the error text.
23479 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23480 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23481 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23485 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
23486 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
23487 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
23488 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23489 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23490 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23491 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23492 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23494 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23495 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23496 configured as follows:
23500 public_name = PLAIN
23502 server_condition = \
23503 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
23504 server_set_id = $auth2
23506 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
23507 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
23508 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
23509 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
23511 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23512 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23513 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23514 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23518 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23520 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23522 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23523 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23527 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23528 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23530 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23531 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
23532 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
23533 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
23534 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
23536 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23537 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23538 authenticating clients it could make sense.
23540 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23541 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23542 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
23543 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
23544 This is an incorrect example:
23546 server_condition = \
23547 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
23549 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
23550 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
23551 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
23552 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
23553 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
23554 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
23555 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
23557 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
23558 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
23560 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
23561 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
23562 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
23563 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
23564 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
23567 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
23568 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
23569 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
23570 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
23571 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
23572 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
23573 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
23577 public_name = LOGIN
23578 server_prompts = User Name : Password
23579 server_condition = \
23580 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
23581 server_set_id = $auth1
23583 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
23584 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
23585 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
23586 strings are used to obtain two data items.
23588 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
23589 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
23590 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
23591 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
23592 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
23596 public_name = LOGIN
23597 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
23598 server_condition = ${if and{{
23600 ldapauth{user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
23601 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
23602 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
23603 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
23606 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
23607 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
23608 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
23609 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
23610 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
23611 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
23612 uninterpreted string.
23616 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
23617 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
23618 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
23619 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
23620 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
23626 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
23627 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
23628 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
23630 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
23631 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
23632 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
23633 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
23636 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
23637 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
23638 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
23639 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
23640 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
23641 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
23642 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
23643 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
23644 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
23645 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
23646 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
23647 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
23649 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
23650 splitting takes priority and happens first.
23652 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
23653 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
23654 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
23655 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
23658 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
23659 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
23663 public_name = PLAIN
23664 client_send = ^username^mysecret
23666 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
23667 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
23668 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
23672 public_name = LOGIN
23673 client_send = : username : mysecret
23675 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
23676 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
23678 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
23679 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
23684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23687 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
23688 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23689 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
23690 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
23691 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
23692 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
23693 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
23694 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
23695 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
23696 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
23697 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
23698 available in plain text at either end.
23701 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
23702 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
23703 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
23704 authenticator as a server:
23706 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23707 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23708 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
23709 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
23710 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
23711 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
23712 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
23713 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
23714 returned to the client.
23716 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
23717 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
23718 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
23719 numeric variables for other things.
23721 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
23722 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
23723 user name, authentication fails.
23727 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23728 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
23729 server_set_id = $auth1
23731 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23732 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
23733 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
23734 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
23738 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23739 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
23741 server_set_id = $auth1
23743 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
23744 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
23747 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
23748 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
23749 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
23753 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
23754 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
23755 computing the response to the server's challenge.
23758 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23759 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
23760 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
23764 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23765 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
23766 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
23767 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
23768 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
23769 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
23770 send the message to the current server.
23772 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
23777 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23779 client_secret = secret
23781 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
23782 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
23786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23789 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
23790 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
23791 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
23792 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
23794 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
23795 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
23797 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
23798 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
23799 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
23800 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
23801 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
23803 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
23804 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
23805 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
23806 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
23808 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
23809 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
23810 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
23811 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
23812 depending on the driver you are using.
23814 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
23815 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
23816 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
23817 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
23818 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
23819 implementation. For example, for Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
23820 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
23821 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
23822 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
23825 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
23826 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
23827 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
23828 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
23829 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
23830 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
23834 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
23835 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
23836 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
23837 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
23840 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
23841 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
23842 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
23843 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
23847 driver = cyrus_sasl
23848 public_name = X-ANYTHING
23849 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
23850 server_set_id = $auth1
23853 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string unset
23854 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
23857 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
23858 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
23861 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
23862 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
23863 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
23864 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
23867 driver = cyrus_sasl
23868 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23869 server_set_id = $auth1
23872 driver = cyrus_sasl
23873 public_name = PLAIN
23874 server_set_id = $auth2
23876 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
23877 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
23878 but it is present in many binary distributions.
23879 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
23880 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
23885 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23886 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23887 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
23888 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
23889 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
23890 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
23891 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
23892 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
23893 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
23894 authenticator only. There is only one option:
23896 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
23898 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
23899 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
23900 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
23901 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
23905 public_name = PLAIN
23906 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23907 server_set_id = $auth2
23912 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23913 server_set_id = $auth1
23915 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
23916 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
23917 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
23918 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
23919 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
23920 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
23921 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
23922 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
23925 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23926 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23928 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
23929 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
23930 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
23931 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
23932 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
23933 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
23934 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
23935 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
23936 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
23937 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
23938 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
23939 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
23940 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
23944 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
23945 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
23947 The server sends back a challenge.
23949 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
23950 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
23953 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
23957 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
23958 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
23959 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
23961 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
23962 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
23963 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
23964 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
23965 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
23966 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
23967 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
23968 for other things. For example:
23973 server_password = \
23974 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
23976 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
23977 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
23983 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
23984 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
23985 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
23989 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
23990 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
23993 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
23994 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
23997 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
23998 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
23999 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
24005 client_username = msn/msn_username
24006 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
24007 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
24009 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
24010 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
24016 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24019 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
24020 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
24021 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
24022 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
24023 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
24026 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
24027 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24028 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24029 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24030 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24031 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
24032 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
24033 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
24034 certificates are used.
24036 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
24037 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
24038 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
24039 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
24040 between them is encrypted.
24042 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
24043 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24044 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24045 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24048 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24049 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24050 in order to get TLS to work.
24054 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24056 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24057 .cindex "smtps protocol"
24058 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24059 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24060 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24061 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24062 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24063 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24064 allocated for this purpose.
24066 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24067 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24068 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24069 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24071 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24073 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24074 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24075 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24076 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24077 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24080 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24081 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24088 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24089 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24090 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24091 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24092 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24096 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24100 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24101 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24103 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24106 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24107 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24109 The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24110 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24111 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24113 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24114 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24115 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24116 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24118 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24119 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24120 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24121 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24122 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24123 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24126 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24127 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24131 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24132 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24133 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24134 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24135 &_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24136 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
24137 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24138 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24139 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24140 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24141 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24143 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24144 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24145 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24146 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24147 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24148 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24149 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24150 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24152 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24153 in &_gnutls-params_& in PEM format, which means that they can be generated
24154 externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24156 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24157 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24158 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24159 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24163 # chown exim:exim new-params
24164 # chmod 0400 new-params
24165 # certtool --generate-privkey --bits 512 >new-params
24166 # echo "" >>new-params
24167 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 1024 >> new-params
24168 # mv new-params gnutls-params
24170 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24171 stalling is removed.
24174 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
24175 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
24176 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
24177 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24178 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24179 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24180 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
24181 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24182 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24185 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24187 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24188 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24189 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24192 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24193 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24194 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24198 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
24201 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24202 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24205 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24206 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24208 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24209 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
24212 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
24213 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24214 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24215 not be moved to the end of the list.
24220 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
24222 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
24223 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
24224 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
24225 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
24226 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
24227 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
24228 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
24229 exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
24230 Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
24231 function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
24232 names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
24233 methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
24234 cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
24235 passed to its control function.
24237 For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
24238 to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
24239 option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
24240 list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
24241 contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
24242 the same as if just AES were given.
24244 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
24245 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
24246 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
24247 There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
24248 &%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
24249 restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
24250 These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
24252 All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
24253 behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
24254 how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
24255 expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
24256 can be changed in the usual way.
24258 Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
24259 first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
24260 default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
24261 specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
24262 exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24264 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
24265 entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
24266 exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
24267 items in the list are ignored. Thus:
24269 tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
24271 allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
24273 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24275 allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
24277 For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
24278 (both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
24279 the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
24280 AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
24282 For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
24283 includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
24284 DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
24286 For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
24287 MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
24289 For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1 and SSL3.
24290 The default list contains TLS1, SSL3.
24292 In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
24293 advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
24294 client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
24295 order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24296 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24301 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
24302 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
24303 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24304 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
24305 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24306 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24307 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
24308 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24310 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
24311 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
24312 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
24315 554 Security failure
24317 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
24318 rejected with a 554 error code.
24320 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
24321 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
24322 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
24323 without some further configuration at the server end.
24325 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
24326 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
24328 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
24329 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
24331 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
24332 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
24333 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
24334 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
24335 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
24336 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
24337 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
24338 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
24339 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
24340 the server's certificate.
24342 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
24343 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
24344 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
24346 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
24347 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
24348 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
24351 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
24352 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
24353 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
24355 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
24357 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
24358 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
24359 suites that the server supports. See the command
24363 for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
24364 when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
24366 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
24367 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
24368 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
24369 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
24370 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
24372 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24373 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24374 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24375 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
24376 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
24377 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
24378 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
24379 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
24380 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
24381 (For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
24384 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
24385 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
24386 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
24387 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
24388 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
24389 documentation for more details.
24392 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
24393 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
24394 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
24395 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
24396 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
24397 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
24398 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
24399 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
24400 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
24401 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
24402 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
24403 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
24405 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
24408 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
24409 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
24410 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
24412 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
24414 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
24416 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
24417 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
24418 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
24419 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
24420 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
24421 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
24422 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
24423 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
24424 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
24425 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
24427 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24428 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
24429 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
24430 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
24432 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24433 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
24434 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
24435 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
24436 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
24437 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
24440 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
24441 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
24442 .cindex "revocation list"
24443 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
24444 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
24445 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
24446 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
24447 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
24448 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
24452 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
24453 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24454 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24455 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24456 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
24457 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
24458 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
24459 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
24460 within the &(smtp)& transport.
24462 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
24463 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
24464 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
24465 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
24466 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
24468 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
24469 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
24470 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
24471 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
24472 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
24475 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
24476 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
24477 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
24478 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
24479 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
24480 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
24481 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
24482 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
24483 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24484 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24487 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
24488 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
24489 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
24490 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
24492 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
24493 must name a file or,
24494 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
24495 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
24496 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
24497 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
24500 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
24501 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
24502 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
24503 alternative hosts, if any.
24507 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
24508 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
24509 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
24514 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24515 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
24516 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
24517 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
24518 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
24520 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24521 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24522 Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
24523 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
24524 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
24525 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
24526 outgoing connection.
24530 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
24532 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
24533 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24534 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
24535 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
24536 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
24537 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
24538 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
24539 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
24540 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
24541 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
24542 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
24544 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
24545 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
24546 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
24547 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
24548 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
24549 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
24550 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
24551 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
24552 and delay other deliveries to that host.
24554 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
24555 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
24556 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
24557 information is recorded.
24559 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
24560 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
24561 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
24566 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
24567 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
24568 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
24569 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
24570 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
24571 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
24572 to Apache, currently at
24574 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
24576 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
24577 links to further files.
24578 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
24579 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
24580 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
24582 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
24586 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
24587 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
24588 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
24589 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
24590 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
24591 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
24592 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
24593 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
24594 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
24595 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
24596 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
24597 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
24598 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
24601 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
24602 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
24603 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
24604 with OpenSSL, like this:
24606 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
24609 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
24610 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
24611 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
24612 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
24613 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
24614 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
24615 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
24617 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
24618 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
24619 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
24621 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
24622 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
24623 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
24624 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
24625 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
24626 signed with that self-signed certificate.
24628 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
24629 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
24630 Open-source PKI book, available online at
24631 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
24632 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
24633 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
24637 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24640 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
24641 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
24642 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
24643 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
24644 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
24645 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
24646 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
24647 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
24648 one very small ACL:
24652 accept hosts = one.host.only
24654 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
24655 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
24657 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
24658 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
24659 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
24660 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
24661 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
24662 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
24663 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
24664 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
24667 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
24668 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
24669 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24670 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
24671 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
24675 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
24676 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
24677 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
24678 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
24679 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
24680 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24681 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
24682 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
24683 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24684 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24685 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
24686 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24687 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
24688 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
24689 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
24690 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24691 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24692 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
24695 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
24696 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
24697 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
24698 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
24699 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
24700 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
24701 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
24702 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
24703 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
24704 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
24705 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
24706 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
24707 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
24708 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
24709 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
24710 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
24711 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
24712 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
24715 For example, if you set
24717 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
24719 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
24720 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
24721 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
24722 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
24723 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
24724 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
24725 testing as possible at RCPT time.
24728 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
24729 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24730 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
24731 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
24732 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
24733 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
24734 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
24735 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
24736 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
24737 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
24738 in any of these ACLs.
24740 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
24741 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
24742 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
24743 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
24744 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
24745 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
24746 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
24747 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
24749 control = suppress_local_fixups
24751 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
24752 run, it is too late.
24754 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24755 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24757 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
24758 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
24759 temporary error for these kinds of message.
24762 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
24763 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24764 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
24765 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
24766 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
24767 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
24768 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
24769 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
24770 &%smtp_banner%& option.
24773 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
24774 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24775 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24776 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
24777 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
24778 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
24779 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
24780 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
24781 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
24783 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
24784 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
24785 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
24786 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
24790 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
24791 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24792 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
24793 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
24794 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
24795 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
24796 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
24797 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
24798 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
24799 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
24801 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
24802 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
24803 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
24804 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
24805 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
24806 associated with the DATA command.
24808 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
24809 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
24810 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
24811 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
24812 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
24816 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
24817 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24818 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24821 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
24822 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24823 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
24824 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
24825 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
24826 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
24828 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
24829 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
24830 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
24831 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
24833 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
24834 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
24836 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
24837 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
24840 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
24841 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
24842 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
24843 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
24844 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
24848 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
24849 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
24850 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
24851 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
24852 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
24853 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
24854 situation even worse.
24857 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
24858 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
24859 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
24862 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
24863 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
24864 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
24865 connection. The possible values are:
24867 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
24868 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
24869 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
24870 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
24871 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
24872 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
24873 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
24874 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
24875 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
24876 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
24878 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
24879 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
24880 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
24881 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
24882 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
24886 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
24887 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
24888 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
24889 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
24891 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
24892 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
24894 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
24895 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
24896 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
24897 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
24898 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
24900 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
24901 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
24902 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
24905 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
24906 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
24907 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
24908 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
24909 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
24910 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
24912 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
24913 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
24914 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
24916 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
24917 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
24918 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
24919 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
24921 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
24922 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
24923 matches the string.
24925 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
24926 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
24927 want to have something like
24929 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
24931 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
24932 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
24938 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
24939 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
24940 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
24941 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
24942 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
24943 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
24944 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
24945 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
24946 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
24948 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
24949 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
24950 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
24953 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
24954 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
24955 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
24956 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
24958 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
24959 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
24960 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
24961 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
24962 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
24963 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
24964 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
24967 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
24968 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
24969 recipients; it may create new recipients.
24973 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
24974 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
24975 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
24976 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
24977 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
24978 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
24980 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
24981 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
24982 used to accept or reject anything.
24984 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
24985 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
24986 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
24987 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
24989 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
24990 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
24991 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
24992 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
24993 configuration file.
24998 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
24999 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
25001 .vindex &$local_part$&
25002 .vindex &$sender_address$&
25003 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
25004 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25005 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
25006 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
25007 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
25008 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
25009 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
25010 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25012 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
25013 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
25014 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
25017 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
25018 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
25019 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
25020 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
25021 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
25024 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
25025 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
25026 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
25027 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
25028 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
25029 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
25030 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
25031 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
25037 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
25038 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
25039 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
25040 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25041 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
25042 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
25043 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25044 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
25045 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
25046 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
25047 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
25048 unencrypted connections.
25051 accept encrypted = *
25052 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
25054 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25056 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25057 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25058 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25059 option to do this.)
25063 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25064 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25065 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25066 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25067 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25068 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25069 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25071 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25072 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25073 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25076 deny dnslists = list1.example
25077 dnslists = list2.example
25079 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25080 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25081 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25082 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25083 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25086 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25087 The ACL verbs are as follows:
25090 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25091 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25092 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25093 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25094 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25095 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25096 check a RCPT command:
25098 accept domains = +local_domains
25102 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25103 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25104 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25105 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25108 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25109 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25110 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25113 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25114 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25115 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25116 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25117 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25118 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25120 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25121 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25123 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25124 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25125 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25127 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25128 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25129 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
25134 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
25135 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
25136 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
25137 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
25138 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
25139 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
25140 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
25144 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
25145 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
25146 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
25149 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25151 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
25155 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
25156 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
25157 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
25158 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
25159 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
25160 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
25161 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
25162 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
25163 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
25165 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
25166 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
25167 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
25171 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
25172 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
25173 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
25175 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
25176 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
25178 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
25179 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
25182 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
25183 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
25184 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
25185 example, when checking a RCPT command,
25187 require message = Sender did not verify
25190 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
25191 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
25192 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
25193 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
25196 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25197 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
25198 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
25199 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
25200 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
25201 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
25202 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
25204 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
25205 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
25206 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
25207 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
25208 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25210 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
25211 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
25212 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
25213 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
25214 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
25215 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
25219 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25220 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
25221 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
25222 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
25224 warn !verify = sender
25225 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
25229 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
25231 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
25232 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
25233 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
25234 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
25235 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
25239 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
25240 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
25241 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
25242 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
25243 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
25244 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
25245 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
25246 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
25247 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
25248 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
25250 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
25251 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
25252 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
25253 on the same SMTP connection.
25255 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
25256 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
25257 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
25260 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
25261 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
25262 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
25264 accept hosts = whatever
25265 set acl_m4 = some value
25266 accept authenticated = *
25267 set acl_c_auth = yes
25269 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
25270 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
25271 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25273 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
25274 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
25275 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
25276 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
25277 error is generated.
25279 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
25280 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
25283 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
25284 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
25285 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
25286 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
25288 deny domains = *.dom.example
25289 !verify = recipient
25291 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
25292 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
25293 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
25294 two statements are equivalent:
25296 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
25297 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
25299 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
25300 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
25302 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25303 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
25304 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
25306 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25307 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
25308 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25309 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
25311 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
25312 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
25313 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
25314 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
25315 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
25316 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
25317 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
25319 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
25320 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
25321 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
25322 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
25323 message is handled.
25325 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
25326 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
25327 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
25328 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
25330 require message = Can't verify sender
25332 message = Can't verify recipient
25334 message = This message cannot be used
25336 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
25337 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
25338 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
25339 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
25340 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
25341 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
25343 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
25344 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
25345 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
25346 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
25349 !senders = *@my.domain.example
25350 message = Invalid sender from client host
25352 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
25353 by which time Exim has set up the message.
25357 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
25358 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
25359 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
25362 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25363 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
25364 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
25365 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25367 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25368 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
25369 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
25370 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
25371 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
25372 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
25373 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
25374 write rather ugly lines like this:
25376 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
25378 Instead, all you need is
25380 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
25383 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25384 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25385 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
25386 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
25387 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
25388 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
25389 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
25390 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
25392 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
25393 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
25394 in several different ways. For example:
25396 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
25397 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
25398 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
25402 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
25404 accept ...some conditions
25405 control = queue_only
25407 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
25408 other words, when the conditions are all true.
25411 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
25413 accept ...some conditions...
25414 control = queue_only
25415 ...some more conditions...
25417 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
25418 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
25419 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
25423 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
25424 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
25427 warn ...some conditions...
25431 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
25432 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
25436 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
25437 &%require%& verb. For example:
25439 require control = no_multiline_responses
25443 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
25444 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
25446 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
25447 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
25448 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
25449 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
25450 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
25451 flushed before the delay is imposed.
25453 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
25456 deny ...some conditions...
25459 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
25460 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
25463 ...some conditions...
25465 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
25466 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
25468 warn ...some conditions...
25474 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
25475 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
25476 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
25477 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
25478 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
25479 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
25480 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
25484 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
25485 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
25486 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
25487 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
25488 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
25489 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
25490 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
25493 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25494 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
25495 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
25496 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
25498 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
25499 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
25501 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
25504 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
25505 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
25507 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
25508 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
25509 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
25512 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
25513 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
25514 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
25515 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
25516 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
25517 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
25520 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25521 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
25522 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
25525 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
25526 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
25527 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
25528 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
25529 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
25530 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
25532 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
25533 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
25534 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
25535 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
25536 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
25537 logging rejections.
25540 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
25541 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
25542 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
25543 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
25544 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
25545 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
25546 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
25547 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
25549 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
25550 &` log_reject_target =`&
25552 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
25553 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
25557 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25558 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
25559 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
25560 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
25561 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
25562 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
25563 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
25566 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
25567 &` control = freeze`&
25568 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
25570 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
25571 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
25572 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
25575 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
25576 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
25580 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25581 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25582 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
25583 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
25584 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
25585 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
25586 &%accept%& for details.)
25588 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
25589 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
25590 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
25591 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
25592 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
25594 require message = Host not recognized
25597 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
25600 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
25601 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
25602 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
25603 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
25604 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
25605 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
25606 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
25607 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
25608 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
25611 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
25612 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
25613 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
25615 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
25616 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
25618 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
25619 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
25620 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
25623 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
25624 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
25626 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
25627 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
25628 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
25631 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25632 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
25633 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
25634 However, the original message is available in the variable
25635 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
25636 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
25637 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
25638 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
25640 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
25641 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
25642 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
25643 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
25644 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
25645 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
25649 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
25650 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
25651 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
25652 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
25659 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
25660 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25661 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
25664 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
25665 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
25666 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
25667 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
25668 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
25669 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
25670 not work without it. For example:
25672 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
25673 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
25675 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
25676 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
25677 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
25678 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
25679 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
25682 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
25683 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
25684 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
25685 .cindex "case of local parts"
25686 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25687 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
25688 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
25689 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
25690 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
25691 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
25694 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
25695 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
25696 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
25697 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
25698 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
25700 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
25701 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
25704 warn control = caseful_local_part
25705 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
25707 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
25709 control = caselower_local_part
25711 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
25712 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
25714 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
25715 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
25716 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
25717 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
25718 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
25719 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
25720 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
25721 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
25723 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25724 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
25725 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
25726 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
25727 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
25728 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
25732 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
25733 .cindex "fake defer"
25734 .cindex "defer, fake"
25735 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
25736 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
25737 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
25738 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
25739 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
25741 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
25742 .cindex "fake rejection"
25743 .cindex "rejection, fake"
25744 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
25745 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
25746 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
25747 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
25748 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25749 the same SMTP connection.
25751 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
25752 message is supplied, the following is used:
25754 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
25755 550-kept for evaluation.
25756 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
25757 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
25759 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
25761 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
25762 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
25763 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25764 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25765 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
25766 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
25769 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
25770 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
25771 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
25772 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
25774 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
25775 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
25776 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
25777 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25778 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
25779 disables such output flushing.
25781 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
25782 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
25783 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
25784 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25785 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
25786 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
25788 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
25789 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
25790 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
25791 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
25792 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
25793 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
25794 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25795 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
25796 to be useful in production.
25798 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
25799 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
25800 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
25801 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
25802 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
25804 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
25805 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
25806 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
25807 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
25808 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
25809 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
25812 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
25813 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
25814 verification failed"&) is sent.
25816 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
25820 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
25821 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
25823 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
25824 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
25825 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
25826 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
25827 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
25828 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
25829 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
25831 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
25832 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
25833 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
25834 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25835 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25836 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
25837 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
25838 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
25839 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
25840 same SMTP connection.
25842 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
25843 .cindex "message" "submission"
25844 .cindex "submission mode"
25845 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
25846 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
25847 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
25848 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
25849 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
25850 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
25851 late (the message has already been created).
25853 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
25854 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
25855 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
25856 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
25857 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
25859 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
25860 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
25861 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
25862 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
25863 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
25866 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
25867 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
25869 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
25871 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
25874 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
25875 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
25876 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
25877 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
25880 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
25881 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
25885 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
25886 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
25889 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
25891 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
25892 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
25894 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
25896 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
25901 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
25902 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
25903 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
25904 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25905 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
25906 to an incoming message, as in this example:
25908 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
25909 dialup.mail-abuse.org
25910 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
25912 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
25913 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
25914 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
25915 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
25916 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
25919 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
25920 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
25921 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
25922 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
25924 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
25925 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
25926 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
25927 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
25928 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
25929 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
25930 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
25931 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
25932 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
25933 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
25934 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
25936 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
25937 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
25938 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
25939 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
25940 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
25941 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
25942 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
25943 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
25944 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
25946 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
25947 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
25949 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25950 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
25952 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
25953 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25955 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
25956 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
25957 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
25958 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
25961 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25962 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
25963 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
25964 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
25965 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
25966 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
25967 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
25970 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
25971 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
25972 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
25973 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
25974 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
25976 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
25977 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
25978 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
25979 to be a header name first.) For example:
25981 warn add_header = \
25982 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
25984 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
25985 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
25986 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
25987 up in reverse order.
25989 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
25990 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
25991 system filter or in a router or transport.
25996 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
25997 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
25998 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
25999 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
26000 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
26001 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26003 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
26004 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
26005 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
26006 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
26007 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
26008 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
26009 The conditions are as follows:
26013 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
26014 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
26015 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
26016 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
26017 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
26018 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
26019 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
26020 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
26021 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
26022 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
26023 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
26025 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
26026 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
26027 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
26028 conditions are tested.
26030 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
26031 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
26032 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
26033 for different local users or different local domains.
26035 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26036 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
26037 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
26038 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
26039 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
26040 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
26041 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
26046 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
26047 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
26048 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
26049 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
26050 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
26051 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
26052 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
26053 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
26054 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
26055 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26056 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26057 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26060 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26061 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26062 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26063 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26064 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26065 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26066 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26067 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26069 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26070 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26071 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26072 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26073 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26075 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26076 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26077 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26078 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26079 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26080 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26081 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26082 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26083 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26084 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26086 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26087 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26088 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26089 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26090 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26091 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26092 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26093 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26094 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26097 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26098 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26101 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26102 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26103 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26104 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26105 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26106 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26107 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26113 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
26114 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
26115 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
26116 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
26117 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
26118 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
26119 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
26121 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26123 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
26124 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
26125 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
26127 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
26128 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
26129 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
26130 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
26131 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
26132 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
26134 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
26135 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
26137 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26138 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
26140 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
26141 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
26142 statement can then check the IP address.
26144 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
26145 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
26146 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
26147 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
26149 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
26150 message = $host_data
26152 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
26154 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
26155 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
26156 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
26157 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
26158 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
26159 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
26160 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
26161 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
26162 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
26163 the next &%local_parts%& test.
26165 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
26166 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
26167 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
26168 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
26169 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26170 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
26171 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26173 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26174 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
26175 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26176 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26177 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26178 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
26179 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
26182 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
26183 .cindex "rate limiting"
26184 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
26185 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
26187 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26188 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
26189 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
26190 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
26191 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
26192 recipient address against a list of recipients.
26194 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26195 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
26196 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26197 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26198 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
26199 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
26200 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26202 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26203 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
26204 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26205 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
26206 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26207 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
26208 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
26209 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
26210 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
26211 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
26212 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
26213 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
26214 influence the sender checking.
26216 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26217 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26219 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26220 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
26221 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26222 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
26223 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
26224 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
26228 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26229 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26231 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
26232 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
26233 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
26234 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26235 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
26236 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26238 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
26239 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26240 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26241 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26242 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
26243 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
26244 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
26245 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
26246 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
26247 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26249 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
26250 .cindex "CSA verification"
26251 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
26252 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
26253 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
26255 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
26256 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26257 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
26258 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
26259 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
26260 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
26261 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26262 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26263 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
26264 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
26265 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
26266 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
26267 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
26268 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
26269 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
26271 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
26272 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
26273 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
26274 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
26277 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
26278 !verify = header_sender
26281 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
26282 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26283 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
26284 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
26285 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
26286 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26287 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26288 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
26289 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
26290 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
26291 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
26292 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26295 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
26296 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
26300 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
26301 common as they used to be.
26303 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
26304 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26305 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
26306 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
26307 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
26308 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
26309 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
26310 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
26311 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
26312 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
26313 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
26314 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
26315 independently of this condition.
26317 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
26318 option), this condition is always true.
26321 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
26322 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
26323 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
26324 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
26325 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
26326 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
26327 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
26328 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
26329 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
26331 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
26332 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
26335 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
26336 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26337 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
26338 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
26339 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
26340 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26341 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
26342 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
26343 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
26344 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
26345 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
26346 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
26347 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
26348 value for the child address.
26350 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
26351 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26352 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
26353 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
26354 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
26355 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
26356 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
26357 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
26358 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
26359 original IP address.
26361 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
26362 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
26364 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
26365 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26366 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
26367 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
26368 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
26369 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
26370 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
26371 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
26372 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
26374 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26375 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
26376 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
26377 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
26378 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
26379 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
26380 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
26382 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
26383 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
26384 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
26386 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
26387 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26388 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
26389 verified as a sender.
26394 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
26395 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26396 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26397 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26398 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
26399 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
26400 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
26401 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
26402 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
26403 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
26405 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
26406 dialups.mail-abuse.org
26408 the following records are looked up:
26410 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26411 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
26413 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
26414 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
26415 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
26416 use two separate conditions:
26418 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26419 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26421 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
26422 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
26423 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
26426 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
26427 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
26428 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
26429 following special items in the list:
26431 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
26432 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
26433 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
26435 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
26436 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
26437 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
26438 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
26440 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
26442 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
26443 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
26445 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26446 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
26447 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26449 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
26450 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
26451 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
26452 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
26456 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
26457 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
26458 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
26459 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
26460 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
26462 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
26464 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
26465 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
26466 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
26467 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
26472 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
26473 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
26474 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
26475 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
26476 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
26477 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
26478 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
26480 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
26481 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26483 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
26484 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
26485 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
26486 up by this example is
26488 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
26490 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
26491 addresses. For example:
26493 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26494 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26496 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
26497 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
26502 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
26503 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
26504 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
26505 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
26506 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
26507 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
26508 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
26509 either to double the separators like this:
26511 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
26513 or to change the separator character, like this:
26515 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
26517 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
26518 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
26519 occurs. Consider this condition:
26521 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
26523 The DNS lookups that occur are:
26525 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
26526 a.domain.black.list.tld
26528 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
26529 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
26530 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
26531 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
26532 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
26533 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
26534 error for a previous item.
26536 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
26537 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
26539 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
26540 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
26542 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
26543 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
26545 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
26546 $sender_address_domain \
26547 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
26549 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
26550 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
26551 $sender_address_domain} }} }
26553 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
26554 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
26555 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
26556 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
26558 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
26560 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
26561 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
26563 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
26564 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
26569 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
26570 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
26571 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
26572 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
26573 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
26574 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
26578 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
26580 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
26581 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
26582 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
26584 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
26585 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
26586 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
26589 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
26590 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
26591 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
26592 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
26593 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
26594 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
26595 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
26596 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
26597 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
26598 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
26599 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
26600 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
26601 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
26602 cases, for example:
26604 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
26606 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
26607 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
26608 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
26609 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
26611 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
26613 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
26614 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
26616 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
26617 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
26618 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
26619 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
26620 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
26623 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
26624 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
26625 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
26627 deny hosts = !+local_networks
26628 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
26630 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
26635 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
26636 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
26637 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
26638 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
26641 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
26643 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
26644 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
26645 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
26646 describes how multiple records are handled.
26648 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
26649 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
26650 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
26652 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26654 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
26655 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
26656 first. For example:
26658 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
26659 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
26662 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
26663 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
26664 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
26665 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
26666 tested. For example:
26668 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
26670 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
26671 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
26672 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
26674 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26676 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
26681 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
26682 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
26685 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26687 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26688 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
26690 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26692 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26693 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
26694 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
26695 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
26697 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
26698 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
26700 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
26701 previous example is precisely equivalent to
26703 deny dnslists = a.b.c
26704 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26706 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
26707 Consider this example:
26709 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26711 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
26714 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
26716 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26718 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
26719 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
26720 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
26722 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
26727 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
26728 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
26729 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
26730 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
26731 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
26732 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
26734 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
26736 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
26737 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
26738 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
26739 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
26740 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
26741 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
26744 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
26745 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
26746 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26748 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
26749 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
26752 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
26754 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26755 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
26757 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
26759 for the condition to be true.
26762 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
26763 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
26765 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
26766 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
26768 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
26770 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26771 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26773 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
26774 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
26776 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
26778 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26779 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
26781 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26783 for the condition to be false.
26785 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
26786 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
26791 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
26792 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
26793 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
26794 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
26795 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
26796 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
26797 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
26798 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
26799 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
26802 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
26803 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
26804 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
26805 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
26806 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
26807 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
26808 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
26811 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
26812 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
26814 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
26815 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26817 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
26818 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
26819 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
26820 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
26821 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
26822 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
26824 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
26825 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
26826 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
26828 reject dnslists = \
26829 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
26830 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
26831 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
26832 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26834 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
26835 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
26836 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
26840 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
26841 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
26842 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
26843 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
26844 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
26845 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
26847 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
26848 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26850 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
26851 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
26852 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
26854 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
26856 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
26857 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
26859 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
26860 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
26862 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
26863 dnslists = some.list.example
26866 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
26867 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
26868 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
26869 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
26870 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
26871 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
26872 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
26873 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
26874 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
26875 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
26877 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
26879 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
26880 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
26882 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
26883 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
26884 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
26887 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
26888 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
26889 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
26890 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
26891 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
26892 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
26893 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
26894 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
26895 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
26897 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
26898 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
26899 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
26900 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
26902 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
26903 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
26904 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
26905 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
26906 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
26907 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
26908 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
26909 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
26910 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
26911 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
26913 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
26914 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
26915 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
26918 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& and the options onto the
26919 lookup key because they alter the meaning of the stored data. This is not true
26920 for the limit &'m'&, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will
26921 still remember clients' past behaviour, but if you alter the other ratelimit
26922 parameters Exim forgets past behaviour.
26924 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to three options. One option
26925 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, and the second specifies how Exim
26926 handles excessively fast clients. The third option can be &`noupdate`&, to
26927 disable updating of the ratelimiting database (see section &<<rearatdat>>&).
26928 The options are separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may
26929 appear in any order.
26931 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
26932 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate.
26934 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
26935 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified.
26937 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. Note that it is
26938 best to use this option in the DATA ACL; if it is used in an earlier ACL it
26939 relies on the SIZE parameter specified by the client in its MAIL command,
26940 which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can follow the limit &'m'&
26941 in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits in kilobytes,
26942 megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
26944 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which
26945 recipients are accepted. To be effective, it would need to be used in
26946 either the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& or the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. In the
26947 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACL, the number of recipients is incremented by one.
26948 In the case of a locally submitted message in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL,
26949 the number of recipients is incremented by the &%$recipients_count%&
26950 for the entire message. Note that in either case the rate limiting
26951 engine will see a message with many recipients as a large high-speed
26954 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
26955 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the SMTP command rate.
26956 This command is essentially an alias of &%per_rcpt%& to make it clear
26957 that the effect is to limit the rate at which individual commands,
26958 rather than recipients, are accepted.
26960 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratophanfas"
26961 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
26962 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
26963 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& options. This is independent of the other
26964 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
26965 rest of the ACL. The default mode is leaky, which avoids a sender's
26966 over-aggressive retry rate preventing it from getting any email through.
26968 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
26969 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
26970 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
26971 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
26972 counter-measures by the ACL until it slows down below the maximum rate. If
26973 the client stops attempting to send email for the time specified in the &'p'&
26974 parameter then its computed rate will decay exponentially to 37% of its peak
26975 value. You can work out the time (the number of smoothing periods) that a
26976 client is subjected to counter-measures after an over-limit burst with this
26979 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
26981 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
26982 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
26983 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
26984 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
26985 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
26986 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
26987 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
26989 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
26990 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
26991 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
26992 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
26993 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
26994 message. For example:
26996 # Log all senders' rates
26997 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
26998 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
27000 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
27001 # at the decimal point.
27002 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
27003 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
27004 $sender_rate_limit }s
27006 # Keep authenticated users under control
27007 deny authenticated = *
27008 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
27010 # System-wide rate limit
27011 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
27012 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
27014 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
27015 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
27016 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
27017 messages per $sender_rate_period
27018 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
27019 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
27020 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
27022 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
27023 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
27024 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
27025 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
27026 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
27027 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
27028 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
27031 .section "Reading ratelimit data without updating" "rearatdat"
27032 .cindex "rate limitint" "reading data without updating"
27033 If the &%noupdate%& option is present on a &%ratelimit%& ACL condition, Exim
27034 computes the rate and checks the limit as normal, but it does not update the
27035 saved data. This means that, in relevant ACLs, it is possible to lookup the
27036 existence of a specified (or auto-generated) ratelimit key without incrementing
27037 the ratelimit counter for that key. In order for this to be useful, another ACL
27038 entry must set the rate for the same key (otherwise it will always be zero).
27042 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd / noupdate
27043 log_message = RATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27044 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27047 &'... some other logic and tests...'&
27051 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd
27052 condition = ${if le{$sender_rate}{$sender_rate_limit}}
27053 logwrite = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27054 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27056 In this example, the rate is tested and used to deny access (when it is too
27057 high) in the connect ACL, but the actual computation of the remembered rate
27058 happens later, on a per-command basis, in another ACL.
27062 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
27063 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
27064 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
27065 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
27066 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
27067 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
27068 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
27069 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
27070 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
27072 verify = sender/callout
27073 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
27075 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
27076 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
27077 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
27078 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
27079 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
27080 The available options are as follows:
27083 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
27084 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
27085 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
27087 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
27088 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
27089 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
27090 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
27092 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
27093 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
27095 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
27096 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
27097 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
27098 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
27101 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
27102 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
27103 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
27104 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27105 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
27106 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
27109 warn !verify = sender
27110 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
27112 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
27113 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
27114 verification failure.
27116 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
27117 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
27120 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
27121 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
27123 &%route%&: Routing failed.
27125 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
27126 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
27127 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
27129 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
27131 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
27134 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
27135 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
27140 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
27141 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
27142 .cindex "callout" "verification"
27143 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
27144 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
27145 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
27146 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
27147 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
27148 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
27149 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
27150 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
27151 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
27154 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
27155 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
27156 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
27157 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
27158 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
27159 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
27161 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
27162 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
27163 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
27164 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
27165 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
27167 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
27168 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
27169 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
27170 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
27171 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
27172 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
27173 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
27174 supplies a host list.
27176 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
27177 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
27178 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
27179 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
27180 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
27181 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
27182 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
27184 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
27185 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
27186 following SMTP commands are sent:
27188 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
27190 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
27193 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
27196 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
27197 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
27198 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
27199 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
27200 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
27201 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
27203 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
27204 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
27205 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
27206 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
27207 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
27209 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27210 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
27211 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
27212 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
27213 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
27218 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
27219 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
27220 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
27221 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
27223 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
27225 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
27226 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
27227 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
27231 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
27232 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
27233 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
27236 verify = sender/callout=5s
27238 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
27239 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
27240 the &%connect%& parameter.
27243 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27244 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
27245 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
27246 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
27248 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
27250 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
27252 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
27253 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
27254 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
27255 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
27256 updated in this circumstance.
27258 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
27259 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
27260 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
27261 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
27262 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
27263 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
27266 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27267 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
27268 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
27269 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
27270 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
27271 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
27272 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
27273 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
27274 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
27275 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
27277 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
27279 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
27282 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27283 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
27284 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
27287 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
27289 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
27290 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
27291 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
27292 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
27293 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
27296 .vitem &*no_cache*&
27297 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
27298 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
27299 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
27301 .vitem &*postmaster*&
27302 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
27303 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
27304 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
27305 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
27306 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
27307 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
27308 made, until the cache record expires.
27310 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27311 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
27312 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
27315 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
27317 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
27318 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
27320 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
27322 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
27323 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
27324 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
27325 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
27329 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
27330 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
27331 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
27332 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
27333 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
27335 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
27337 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
27338 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
27339 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
27340 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
27341 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
27343 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
27344 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
27345 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27347 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
27349 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
27350 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
27351 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
27352 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
27353 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
27355 .vitem &*use_sender*&
27356 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27358 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
27360 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
27361 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
27362 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
27363 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
27364 usefulness of callout caching.
27367 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
27368 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
27369 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
27370 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
27371 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
27372 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
27373 these circumstances.
27375 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
27376 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
27377 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
27378 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
27379 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
27380 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
27381 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
27383 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
27384 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
27385 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
27386 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
27391 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
27392 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
27393 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
27394 .cindex "caching" "callout"
27395 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
27396 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
27397 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
27398 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
27399 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
27400 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
27402 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
27403 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
27406 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
27407 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
27408 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
27410 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
27411 commands up to and including
27415 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
27416 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
27417 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
27418 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
27419 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
27420 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
27421 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
27423 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
27424 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
27425 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
27426 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
27427 will eventually be noticed.
27429 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
27430 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
27431 behaviour will be the same.
27435 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
27436 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
27437 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
27438 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
27439 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
27440 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
27443 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
27445 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
27446 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
27447 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
27448 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
27449 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
27450 550 Sender verification failed
27452 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
27453 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
27454 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
27455 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
27458 verify = sender/no_details
27461 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
27462 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
27463 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
27464 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
27465 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
27466 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
27467 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
27470 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
27471 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
27472 verification also fails.
27474 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
27475 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
27478 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
27479 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
27480 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
27483 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
27485 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
27486 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
27487 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
27488 verification to succeed.
27490 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
27491 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
27492 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
27493 option. For example:
27495 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
27497 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
27498 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
27500 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
27501 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
27502 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
27503 address and a report is output for each of them.
27507 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
27508 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
27509 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
27510 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
27511 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
27512 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
27513 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
27517 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
27518 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
27519 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
27520 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
27521 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
27522 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
27524 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
27525 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
27526 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
27527 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
27530 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
27532 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
27534 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
27535 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
27537 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
27538 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
27541 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
27542 use for the DNS query. The default is:
27544 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
27546 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
27547 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
27548 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
27549 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
27552 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
27554 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
27555 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
27556 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
27558 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
27559 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
27560 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
27561 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
27562 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
27563 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
27564 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
27565 of legitimate HELO domains.
27567 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
27568 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
27569 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
27570 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
27573 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
27575 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
27576 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
27577 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
27582 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
27583 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
27584 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
27585 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
27586 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
27587 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
27588 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
27589 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
27591 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
27592 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
27593 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
27594 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
27595 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
27596 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
27597 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
27599 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
27600 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
27603 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
27604 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
27607 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
27608 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
27611 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
27612 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
27614 recipients = +batv_senders
27616 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
27617 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
27619 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
27620 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
27621 !condition = $prvscheck_result
27623 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
27624 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
27625 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
27626 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
27627 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
27629 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
27630 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
27631 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
27632 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
27633 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
27634 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
27635 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
27638 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
27639 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
27640 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
27641 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
27646 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
27648 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
27649 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
27650 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
27653 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
27656 external_smtp_batv:
27658 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
27659 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
27660 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
27661 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
27664 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
27668 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
27669 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
27670 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
27671 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
27672 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
27673 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
27674 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
27675 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
27676 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
27677 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
27679 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
27680 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
27681 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
27682 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
27683 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
27684 same host is fulfilling both functions,
27686 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
27688 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
27689 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
27690 system to arbitrary domains.
27693 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
27694 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
27695 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
27696 example, suppose you want to do the following:
27699 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
27700 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
27701 &'my.dom2.example'&.
27703 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
27704 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
27706 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
27707 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
27711 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
27713 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
27714 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
27715 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
27717 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
27721 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
27722 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
27724 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
27725 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
27726 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
27727 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
27728 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
27729 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
27730 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27734 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
27735 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
27736 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
27737 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
27738 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27740 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
27741 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
27742 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
27743 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
27744 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
27745 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
27746 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
27751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27752 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27754 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
27755 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
27756 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
27757 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
27758 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
27759 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
27762 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
27763 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
27764 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
27765 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
27766 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
27768 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
27769 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
27770 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
27773 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
27774 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
27776 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
27777 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
27778 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
27780 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
27781 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
27783 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
27786 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
27789 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
27790 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
27791 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
27793 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
27794 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
27795 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
27796 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
27797 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
27798 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
27800 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
27801 temporarily created in a file called:
27803 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
27805 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
27806 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
27807 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
27808 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
27809 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
27811 control = no_mbox_unspool
27813 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
27814 same directory by default.
27818 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
27819 .cindex "virus scanning"
27820 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
27821 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
27822 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
27823 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
27824 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
27825 in memory and thus are much faster.
27827 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
27828 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
27829 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
27830 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
27832 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
27834 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
27836 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
27838 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
27839 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
27842 .vitem &%aveserver%&
27843 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27844 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
27845 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
27846 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
27849 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
27853 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
27854 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
27855 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
27856 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
27857 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
27858 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
27859 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
27861 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
27862 av_scanner = clamd:192.168.2.100 1234
27864 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
27865 contributing the code for this scanner.
27868 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
27869 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
27870 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
27871 type takes 3 mandatory options:
27874 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
27875 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
27878 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
27879 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
27880 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
27881 the &"trigger"& expression.
27884 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
27885 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
27886 &"name"& expression.
27889 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
27891 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
27893 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
27894 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
27895 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
27896 configuration setting:
27898 av_scanner = cmdline:\
27899 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
27900 found in file:'(.+)'
27903 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
27904 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
27905 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
27906 separated by white space, as in these examples:
27908 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
27909 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
27911 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
27912 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
27915 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
27916 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
27917 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
27919 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
27921 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
27922 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
27924 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
27925 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27926 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
27927 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
27928 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
27931 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
27933 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
27936 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
27937 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
27938 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
27939 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
27940 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
27941 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
27942 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
27944 av_scanner = mksd:2
27946 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
27949 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
27950 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
27951 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
27952 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
27953 client communication. For example:
27955 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
27957 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
27961 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
27962 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
27965 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
27966 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
27967 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
27968 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
27969 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
27970 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
27973 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
27974 use. It can then be one of
27977 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
27978 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
27981 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
27982 the condition fails immediately.
27984 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
27985 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
27986 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
27989 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
27990 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
27991 causes the ACL to defer.
27993 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
27994 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
27995 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
27996 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
27999 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
28000 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
28001 &%malware%& condition.
28003 Here is a very simple scanning example:
28005 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28009 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
28011 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28013 malware = */defer_ok
28015 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
28016 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
28018 av_scanner = $acl_m0
28020 in the main Exim configuration.
28022 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28023 set acl_m0 = sophie
28026 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28027 set acl_m0 = aveserver
28032 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
28033 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
28034 .cindex "spam scanning"
28035 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
28036 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
28037 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
28038 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
28039 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
28041 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
28043 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
28044 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
28047 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
28048 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
28049 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
28050 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
28051 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
28053 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
28055 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
28056 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
28057 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
28060 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
28062 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
28063 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
28064 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
28065 option, separated with colons:
28067 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
28068 192.168.2.11 783 : \
28071 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
28072 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
28073 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
28076 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
28077 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
28079 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
28080 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
28081 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
28084 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
28085 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
28087 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28090 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
28091 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
28092 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
28093 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
28094 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
28096 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
28097 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
28098 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
28099 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
28100 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
28103 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
28104 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
28105 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
28108 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
28109 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
28110 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
28113 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28114 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
28118 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
28119 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
28120 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
28121 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
28123 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
28124 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
28125 variables. With the exception of &$spam_score_int$&, these are usable only
28126 within ACLs; their values are not retained with the message and so cannot be
28127 used at delivery time.
28130 .vitem &$spam_score$&
28131 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
28132 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
28134 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
28135 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
28136 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
28137 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
28138 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in
28139 conditions. This variable is special; its value is saved with the message, and
28140 written to Exim's spool file. This means that it can be used during the whole
28141 life of the message on your Exim system, in particular, in routers or
28142 transports during the later delivery phase.
28144 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
28145 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
28146 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
28147 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
28148 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
28150 .vitem &$spam_report$&
28151 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
28152 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
28155 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
28156 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
28157 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
28159 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
28160 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
28161 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
28162 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
28163 spam condition, like this:
28165 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28166 spam = joe/defer_ok
28168 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
28170 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
28173 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
28174 warn spam = nobody:true
28175 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
28176 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
28178 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
28179 # is over threshold
28181 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
28183 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
28184 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
28186 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
28191 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
28192 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
28193 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28194 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
28195 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
28196 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
28197 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
28198 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
28199 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
28200 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
28203 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
28204 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
28205 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
28206 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
28207 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
28208 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
28209 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
28211 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
28212 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
28213 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
28214 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
28215 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
28217 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
28218 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
28219 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
28220 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
28221 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
28224 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
28226 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
28230 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
28232 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
28233 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
28234 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
28235 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
28237 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
28238 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
28239 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
28240 the full path and file name.
28242 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
28243 filename, and the default path is then used.
28245 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
28246 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
28247 a file with its original, proposed filename using
28249 decode = $mime_filename
28251 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
28252 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
28253 automatically unlinked.
28255 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
28256 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
28257 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
28258 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
28259 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
28261 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
28262 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
28263 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
28265 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
28266 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
28267 available in the MIME ACL:
28270 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
28271 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
28272 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
28273 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
28274 contains the empty string.
28276 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
28277 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
28278 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
28284 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
28285 case-insensitively.
28287 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
28288 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
28289 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
28290 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
28291 only used for display purposes.
28293 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
28294 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
28295 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
28297 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
28298 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
28299 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
28301 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
28302 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28303 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
28304 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
28305 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
28307 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
28308 This variable contains the normalized content of the
28309 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
28310 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
28312 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
28313 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
28314 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
28315 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
28319 application/octet-stream
28323 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
28326 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
28327 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28328 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
28329 containing the decoded data.
28334 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
28335 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
28336 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
28337 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
28338 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
28339 found, this variable contains the empty string.
28341 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
28342 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
28343 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
28344 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
28346 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
28347 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
28351 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
28354 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
28355 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
28358 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
28359 and the rest are attachments.
28362 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
28365 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
28366 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
28367 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
28369 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
28370 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
28371 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
28372 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
28374 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
28375 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
28376 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
28377 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
28378 want to carry out specific actions on them.
28380 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
28381 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
28382 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
28383 decoding is fully recursive.
28385 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
28386 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
28387 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
28388 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
28389 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
28390 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
28391 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
28396 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
28397 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
28398 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
28399 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
28400 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
28402 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
28403 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
28404 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
28405 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
28406 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
28408 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
28409 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
28410 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
28411 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
28412 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
28413 32K characters are checked.
28415 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
28416 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
28417 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
28418 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
28419 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
28421 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
28422 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
28424 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
28425 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
28426 matching regular expression.
28428 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
28434 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
28435 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
28436 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28437 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
28438 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
28439 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
28440 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
28441 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
28442 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
28443 use the &%demime%& condition.
28445 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
28446 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
28447 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
28448 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
28449 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
28450 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
28452 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
28453 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
28456 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
28457 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
28459 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
28460 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
28461 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
28462 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
28464 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
28465 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
28466 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
28468 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
28471 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
28472 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
28473 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
28474 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
28475 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
28476 zero, no error occurred.
28478 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
28479 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
28480 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
28481 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
28485 .vitem &$found_extension$&
28486 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
28487 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
28488 extension it found.
28491 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
28492 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
28494 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
28495 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
28496 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
28499 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
28500 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
28502 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
28504 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
28505 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
28506 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
28507 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
28509 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
28510 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
28511 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
28520 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28521 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28523 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
28524 "Local scan function"
28525 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
28526 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
28527 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
28528 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
28529 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
28531 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
28532 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
28533 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
28534 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
28535 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
28537 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
28538 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
28539 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
28540 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
28542 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
28543 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
28544 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
28545 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
28547 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
28548 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
28549 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
28550 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
28551 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
28552 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
28553 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
28554 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
28555 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
28559 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
28560 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
28561 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
28562 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
28563 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
28564 directory, so you might set
28566 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
28568 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
28569 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
28570 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
28571 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
28572 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
28573 _src/local_scan.c_.
28575 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
28576 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
28578 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28580 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
28585 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
28586 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
28587 You must include this line near the start of your code:
28589 #include "local_scan.h"
28591 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
28592 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
28593 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
28594 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
28595 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
28596 strings and pointers to character strings:
28598 #define CS (char *)
28599 #define CCS (const char *)
28600 #define CSS (char **)
28601 #define US (unsigned char *)
28602 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
28603 #define USS (unsigned char **)
28605 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
28607 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
28609 The arguments are as follows:
28612 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
28613 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
28614 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
28616 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
28617 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
28618 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
28619 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
28620 case this changes in some future version.
28622 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
28623 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
28626 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
28629 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
28630 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
28631 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
28632 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
28633 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
28634 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
28636 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
28637 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28638 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
28640 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
28641 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28642 queued without immediate delivery.
28644 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
28645 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
28646 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
28647 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
28648 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
28651 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
28652 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
28653 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
28656 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28657 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
28658 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
28659 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
28660 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
28661 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
28662 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28664 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28665 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
28666 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28669 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
28670 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
28671 &%-oe%& command line options.
28675 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
28676 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
28677 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
28678 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
28679 want to do this, you must have the line
28681 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28683 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
28684 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
28685 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
28688 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
28689 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
28690 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
28691 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
28692 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
28693 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
28695 static int my_integer_option = 42;
28696 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
28698 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
28699 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
28700 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
28703 int local_scan_options_count =
28704 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
28706 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
28707 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
28711 my_string = some string of text...
28713 The available types of option data are as follows:
28716 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
28717 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
28718 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
28719 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
28720 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
28721 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
28724 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
28725 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
28726 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
28727 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
28730 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
28731 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
28734 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
28735 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
28736 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
28737 printed with the suffix K or M.
28739 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
28740 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
28741 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
28742 always output in octal.
28744 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
28745 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
28746 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
28748 .vitem &*opt_time*&
28749 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
28750 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
28753 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
28754 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
28758 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
28759 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
28760 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
28761 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
28762 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
28763 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
28764 C variables are as follows:
28767 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
28768 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
28770 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
28771 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
28773 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
28774 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
28775 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
28776 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
28779 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
28780 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
28781 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
28784 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
28785 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
28789 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
28790 selected, you should use code like this:
28792 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28793 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28795 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
28796 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
28797 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
28799 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
28800 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
28803 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
28804 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
28806 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
28807 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
28809 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
28810 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
28811 &%-bh%& command line option.
28813 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
28814 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
28815 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
28817 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
28818 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
28819 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
28820 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
28822 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
28823 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
28824 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
28826 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
28827 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
28829 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
28830 The number of accepted recipients.
28832 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
28833 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
28834 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
28835 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
28836 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
28837 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
28838 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
28839 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
28840 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
28841 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
28842 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
28843 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
28845 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
28846 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
28848 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
28849 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
28850 locally-submitted messages.
28852 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
28853 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
28854 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
28856 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
28857 The name of the sending host, if known.
28859 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
28860 The port on the sending host.
28862 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
28863 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
28865 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
28866 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
28868 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
28869 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
28870 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
28874 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
28875 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
28876 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
28877 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
28882 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
28883 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
28885 .vitem &*int&~type*&
28886 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
28887 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
28888 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
28889 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
28890 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
28891 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
28893 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
28894 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
28897 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
28898 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
28899 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
28904 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
28905 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
28908 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
28909 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
28911 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
28912 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
28913 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
28914 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
28916 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
28917 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
28918 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
28919 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
28920 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
28921 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
28922 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
28923 is NULL for all recipients.
28928 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
28929 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
28930 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
28931 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
28935 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
28936 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
28938 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
28939 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
28940 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
28941 for the process in &%newumask%&.
28943 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
28944 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
28945 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
28946 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
28947 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
28949 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
28951 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
28952 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
28953 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
28954 return value is as follows:
28959 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
28965 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
28971 The process timed out.
28975 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
28978 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
28979 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
28980 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
28981 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
28982 forks a subprocess that is running
28984 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
28986 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
28987 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
28988 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
28989 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
28991 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
28992 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
28993 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
28994 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
28997 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
28998 *sender_authentication)*&
28999 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
29002 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
29004 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
29007 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29008 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
29009 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
29010 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
29011 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
29013 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29014 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29017 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
29018 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
29019 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
29020 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
29021 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
29022 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
29023 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
29024 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
29026 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
29027 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
29028 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
29029 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
29030 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
29031 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
29033 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29034 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
29035 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
29036 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
29038 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
29039 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
29040 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
29041 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
29042 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
29043 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
29044 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
29045 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
29046 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
29047 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
29049 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
29050 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
29052 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
29053 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
29056 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
29057 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
29058 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
29059 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
29060 match the specification, the function does nothing.
29063 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29064 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
29065 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
29066 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
29067 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
29068 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
29070 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
29072 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
29073 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
29074 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
29075 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
29076 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
29079 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
29080 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
29081 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
29082 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
29083 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
29084 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
29085 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
29086 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
29088 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
29089 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
29090 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
29092 &`OK `& match succeeded
29093 &`FAIL `& match failed
29094 &`DEFER `& match deferred
29096 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
29097 inability to contact a database.
29099 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29101 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
29102 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
29103 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29105 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29107 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
29108 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
29109 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29111 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
29113 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
29116 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
29118 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
29119 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
29120 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
29121 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
29122 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
29123 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
29126 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
29128 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
29129 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
29130 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
29131 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
29132 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
29133 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
29136 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
29137 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
29138 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
29139 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
29141 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
29142 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
29143 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
29144 value afterwards. For example:
29146 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
29147 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
29148 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
29151 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
29152 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
29153 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
29154 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
29161 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
29162 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
29163 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
29164 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
29165 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
29166 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
29167 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
29168 binary string is returned with an error message.
29170 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
29171 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
29172 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
29174 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
29175 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
29176 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
29177 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
29178 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
29180 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
29181 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
29182 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
29184 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
29185 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
29186 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
29187 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
29191 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
29192 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
29195 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29196 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
29197 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
29198 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
29199 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
29200 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
29201 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
29202 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
29205 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
29206 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
29208 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
29209 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
29210 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
29211 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
29212 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
29213 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
29214 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
29216 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
29217 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
29219 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
29220 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
29221 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
29222 multiple output lines.
29224 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
29225 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
29226 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
29227 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
29228 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
29229 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
29230 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
29233 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
29234 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
29235 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
29236 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29238 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
29239 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
29240 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29242 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
29245 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
29248 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
29249 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
29250 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
29251 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
29252 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
29253 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
29259 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
29260 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
29261 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
29262 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
29263 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
29264 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
29265 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
29268 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
29269 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
29270 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
29271 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
29273 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
29274 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
29276 store_pool = POOL_PERM
29278 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
29279 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
29280 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
29281 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
29283 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
29284 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
29285 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
29286 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
29293 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29294 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29296 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
29297 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
29298 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
29299 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
29300 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
29301 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
29302 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
29303 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
29305 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
29306 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
29307 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
29308 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
29309 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
29311 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
29312 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
29313 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
29314 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
29315 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
29316 prevent it happening on retries.
29318 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29319 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29320 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
29321 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
29322 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
29323 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
29324 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
29325 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
29328 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
29329 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
29330 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
29331 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
29332 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
29333 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
29334 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
29336 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
29337 system_filter_user = exim
29339 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
29340 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
29341 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
29342 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
29343 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
29344 by the &%reply%& command.
29347 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
29348 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
29349 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
29350 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
29352 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
29353 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
29357 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
29358 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
29359 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
29360 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
29361 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
29362 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
29365 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
29366 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
29367 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
29368 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
29369 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
29370 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
29371 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
29373 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
29374 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
29375 succeed, it will not be tried again.
29376 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
29377 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
29379 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
29380 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
29381 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
29382 to which users' filter files can refer.
29386 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
29387 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
29388 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
29389 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
29390 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
29394 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
29395 .cindex "freezing messages"
29396 .cindex "message" "freezing"
29397 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
29398 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
29399 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
29400 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
29401 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
29402 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
29403 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
29404 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
29405 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
29407 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
29409 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
29411 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
29412 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
29413 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
29414 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
29415 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
29418 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
29419 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
29420 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
29421 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
29423 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
29424 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
29425 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
29426 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
29427 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
29428 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
29429 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
29430 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
29431 message. For example:
29433 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
29434 because it contains attachments that we are \
29435 not prepared to receive."
29438 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
29439 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
29440 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
29441 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
29442 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
29443 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
29446 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
29447 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
29449 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
29450 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
29451 generated by the filter.
29453 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
29455 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
29456 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
29462 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
29463 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
29468 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
29469 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
29470 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
29471 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
29472 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
29474 headers add <string>
29475 headers remove <string>
29477 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
29478 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
29479 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
29480 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
29481 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
29483 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
29484 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
29485 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
29488 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
29489 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
29492 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
29493 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
29494 space after input continuations is ignored.
29496 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
29497 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
29498 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
29499 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
29500 header with the same name, they are all removed.
29502 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
29503 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
29504 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
29505 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
29506 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
29507 used for all recipients of the message.
29509 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
29510 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
29511 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
29512 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
29513 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
29514 until the message is actually being written (see section
29515 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
29517 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
29518 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
29519 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
29520 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
29521 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
29522 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
29523 modified more than once.
29525 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
29526 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
29529 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
29530 headers remove "Subject"
29531 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
29532 headers remove "Old-Subject"
29537 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
29538 .cindex "envelope sender"
29539 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
29541 errors_to <some address>
29543 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
29544 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
29545 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
29548 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
29550 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
29551 address if its delivery failed.
29555 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
29556 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29557 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29558 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
29559 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
29560 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
29561 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
29562 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
29563 which implements such a filter:
29568 domains = +local_domains
29569 file = /central/filters/$local_part
29574 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
29575 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
29576 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
29577 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
29579 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
29580 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
29581 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
29582 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
29584 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
29585 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
29586 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
29593 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29594 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29596 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
29597 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
29598 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
29599 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
29600 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
29601 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
29602 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
29603 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
29605 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
29606 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
29607 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
29608 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
29609 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
29611 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
29612 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
29613 loopback interface specially in any way.
29615 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
29616 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
29621 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
29622 .cindex "message" "submission"
29623 .cindex "submission mode"
29624 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
29625 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
29626 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
29627 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
29629 control = submission
29631 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
29632 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
29633 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
29634 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
29635 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
29636 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
29638 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
29639 control = submission
29641 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
29642 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
29643 is used to separate options. For example:
29645 control = submission/sender_retain
29647 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
29648 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
29649 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
29650 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
29651 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
29652 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
29653 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
29655 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
29656 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
29659 control = submission/domain=some.domain
29661 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
29662 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
29663 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
29664 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
29666 accept authenticated = *
29667 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
29668 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
29669 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
29671 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
29672 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
29673 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
29675 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
29677 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
29680 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
29682 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
29683 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
29684 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
29685 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
29687 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
29688 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
29689 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
29690 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
29691 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
29692 spoof another's address.
29694 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
29695 .cindex "line endings"
29696 .cindex "carriage return"
29698 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
29699 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
29700 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
29701 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
29702 use CRLF or just CR.
29704 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
29705 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
29706 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
29707 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
29708 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
29709 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
29710 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
29711 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
29715 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
29717 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
29720 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
29721 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
29724 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
29725 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
29726 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
29727 people trying to play silly games.
29729 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
29730 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
29738 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
29739 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
29740 .cindex "address" "qualification"
29741 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
29742 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
29743 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
29744 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
29745 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
29747 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
29748 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
29749 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
29750 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
29751 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
29753 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
29754 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
29755 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
29756 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
29757 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
29758 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
29759 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
29760 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
29765 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
29766 .cindex "&""From""& line"
29767 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
29768 .cindex "sender" "address"
29769 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
29770 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
29771 .cindex "envelope sender"
29772 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29773 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
29774 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
29775 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
29777 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
29778 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
29780 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
29781 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
29782 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
29783 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
29784 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
29785 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
29786 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
29787 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
29788 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
29790 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
29791 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
29792 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
29793 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
29794 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
29795 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
29796 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
29798 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
29799 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
29800 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
29802 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
29803 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
29804 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
29805 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
29809 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
29810 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
29811 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
29812 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
29813 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
29814 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
29815 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
29818 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
29819 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
29822 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
29823 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
29827 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
29828 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
29830 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
29831 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
29832 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
29834 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
29837 For a locally-submitted message,
29838 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
29839 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
29840 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
29841 included in log lines in this case.
29843 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
29844 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
29850 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
29851 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
29852 includes the header line:
29854 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
29857 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
29858 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
29859 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
29860 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
29861 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
29862 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
29865 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
29866 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
29867 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
29868 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
29869 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
29871 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
29872 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
29873 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
29874 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
29875 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
29876 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
29877 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
29878 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
29882 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
29883 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
29884 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
29885 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
29886 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
29887 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
29888 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
29889 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
29893 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
29894 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
29895 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29896 .cindex "message" "submission"
29897 .cindex "submission mode"
29898 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
29899 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
29902 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
29903 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
29905 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29906 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
29908 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29909 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
29910 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
29912 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
29913 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
29915 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
29916 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
29920 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
29922 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
29923 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
29924 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
29925 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29926 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
29927 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
29928 &%qualify_domain%&.
29930 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
29931 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
29932 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
29933 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29936 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
29937 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
29938 .cindex "message" "submission"
29939 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
29940 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
29941 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
29942 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
29943 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
29944 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
29945 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
29946 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
29947 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
29948 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
29951 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
29952 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
29953 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
29954 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
29955 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
29957 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
29958 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
29959 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
29960 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
29962 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
29963 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
29964 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
29967 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
29968 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
29969 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
29970 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
29971 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
29972 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
29973 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
29974 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
29975 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
29976 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
29977 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
29981 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
29982 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
29983 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
29984 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
29985 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
29986 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
29987 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
29988 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
29992 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
29993 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
29994 .cindex "message" "submission"
29995 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
29996 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
29997 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
29998 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30001 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
30002 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30003 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
30004 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
30005 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
30006 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
30007 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
30008 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
30009 line is added to the message.
30011 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
30012 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
30013 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
30014 options true at the same time.
30016 .cindex "submission mode"
30017 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
30018 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
30019 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
30020 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
30022 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30023 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
30024 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
30025 created as follows:
30028 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30029 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30030 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30032 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
30033 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30035 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30036 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30039 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
30040 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
30041 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
30042 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
30044 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
30045 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
30046 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
30047 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
30051 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
30052 "SECTheadersaddrem"
30053 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
30054 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
30055 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
30056 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
30057 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
30058 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
30059 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
30061 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
30062 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
30063 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
30064 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
30065 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
30066 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
30068 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
30069 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
30070 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
30072 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
30073 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
30074 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
30076 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
30077 X-added-second: another added header line
30079 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
30081 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
30082 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
30083 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
30084 not part of the names. For example:
30086 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
30088 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
30089 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
30090 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
30091 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
30092 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
30094 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
30095 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
30096 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
30097 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
30099 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
30100 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
30101 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
30104 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
30105 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
30106 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
30107 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
30108 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
30109 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
30110 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
30112 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
30113 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
30114 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
30115 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
30117 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
30118 the following consequences:
30121 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
30122 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
30123 to it, at all times.
30125 Header lines that are added by a router's
30126 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
30127 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
30129 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
30130 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
30132 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
30133 a later router or by a transport.
30135 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
30136 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
30138 headers_remove = subject
30139 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
30143 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
30144 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
30150 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
30151 .cindex "address" "constructed"
30152 .cindex "constructed address"
30153 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
30156 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
30160 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
30162 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
30163 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
30164 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
30165 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
30166 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
30167 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
30168 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
30169 there is no password file entry.
30172 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
30173 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
30174 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
30175 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
30176 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
30177 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
30178 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
30179 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
30183 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
30184 .cindex "case of local parts"
30185 .cindex "local part" "case of"
30186 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
30187 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
30188 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
30189 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
30190 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
30191 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
30194 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
30195 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
30196 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
30197 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
30198 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
30202 domains = +local_domains
30203 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
30204 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
30207 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
30208 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
30209 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
30210 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
30211 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
30215 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
30216 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
30217 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
30218 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
30219 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
30220 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
30221 empty components for compatibility.
30225 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
30226 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
30227 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
30228 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
30229 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
30230 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
30232 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
30233 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
30234 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
30235 example, a header such as
30239 might get rewritten as
30241 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
30243 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
30244 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
30247 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
30248 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
30249 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
30250 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
30251 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
30252 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
30253 .ecindex IIDmesproc
30257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30258 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30260 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
30261 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
30262 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
30263 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
30264 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
30265 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
30266 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
30269 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
30271 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
30273 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
30276 For mail delivery, the following are available:
30279 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
30281 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
30284 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
30287 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
30288 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
30291 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
30292 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
30293 used to contain the envelope information.
30297 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
30298 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
30299 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
30300 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
30301 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
30304 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30305 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
30306 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
30307 processing is the same in both cases.
30309 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
30310 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
30311 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
30312 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
30313 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
30314 .cindex "transport" "filter"
30315 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
30316 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
30319 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
30320 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
30321 required for the transaction.
30323 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
30324 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
30325 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
30327 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
30328 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
30329 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
30331 .cindex "carriage return"
30333 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30334 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
30335 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30338 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
30339 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
30340 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
30341 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
30342 of the &%max_rcpts%& option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
30343 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpts%& addresses
30344 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
30345 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
30346 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
30348 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
30349 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
30350 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
30351 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
30353 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
30354 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
30355 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
30356 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
30358 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
30359 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
30360 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
30361 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
30362 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
30363 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
30364 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
30365 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
30366 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
30367 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
30369 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
30370 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
30372 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
30373 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
30374 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
30375 square bracket of the IP address.
30380 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
30381 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
30382 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
30383 .cindex "host" "error"
30384 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
30385 message errors, and recipient errors.
30388 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
30389 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
30390 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
30393 Connection refused or timed out,
30395 Any error response code on connection,
30397 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
30399 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
30401 I/O errors at any time,
30403 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
30404 the &"."& at the end of the data.
30407 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
30408 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
30409 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
30410 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
30411 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
30412 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
30413 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
30414 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
30416 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
30417 .cindex "message" "error"
30418 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
30419 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
30420 message errors are:
30423 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
30426 Timeout after MAIL,
30428 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
30429 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
30430 connection at any other time.
30433 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
30434 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
30435 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
30436 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
30437 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
30438 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
30439 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
30440 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
30441 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
30442 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
30444 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
30445 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
30446 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
30449 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
30450 .cindex "recipient" "error"
30451 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
30452 recipient errors are:
30455 Any error response to RCPT,
30457 Timeout after RCPT.
30460 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
30461 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
30462 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
30463 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
30464 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
30465 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
30466 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
30467 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
30468 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
30469 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
30470 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
30471 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
30472 the retry clock is reset.
30474 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
30475 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
30476 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
30477 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
30478 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
30479 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
30480 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
30481 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
30482 recipient's retry time.
30485 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
30486 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
30487 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
30488 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
30489 until the next delivery attempt.
30491 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
30492 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
30493 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
30494 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
30495 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
30498 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
30499 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
30500 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
30501 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
30502 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
30503 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
30504 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
30506 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
30507 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
30508 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
30509 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
30510 then to be treated as a host error.
30512 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
30513 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
30514 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
30515 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
30516 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
30521 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
30522 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
30523 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
30526 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
30527 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
30528 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
30530 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
30532 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
30533 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
30534 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
30535 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
30536 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
30537 stream and exits with an error code.
30539 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
30540 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
30541 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
30542 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
30544 .cindex "carriage return"
30546 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30547 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
30548 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30550 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
30551 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
30552 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
30554 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
30555 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
30556 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
30557 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
30558 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
30559 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
30560 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
30561 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
30563 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30564 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
30565 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
30566 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
30567 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
30568 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
30569 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
30570 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
30571 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
30573 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
30574 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
30575 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
30577 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
30578 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
30579 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
30580 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
30581 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
30583 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
30584 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
30585 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
30586 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
30587 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
30588 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
30589 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
30591 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
30592 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
30593 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
30594 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
30595 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
30597 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
30598 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
30599 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
30600 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
30601 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
30602 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
30603 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
30604 a delivery process.
30606 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
30607 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
30608 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
30609 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
30610 however, available with &'inetd'&.
30612 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
30613 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
30614 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
30615 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
30617 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
30618 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
30619 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
30623 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
30624 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
30625 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
30626 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
30627 the error response to the last command. The default value for
30628 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
30629 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
30630 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
30633 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
30634 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
30635 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
30636 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
30637 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
30638 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
30639 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
30640 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
30641 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
30642 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
30643 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
30647 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
30648 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
30649 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
30650 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
30651 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
30652 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
30653 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
30654 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
30656 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
30657 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
30658 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
30659 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
30660 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
30663 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
30664 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
30665 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
30667 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
30668 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
30669 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
30670 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
30671 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
30676 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
30677 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
30678 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
30679 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
30680 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30682 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
30683 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
30684 called with the &%-bv%& option.
30686 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
30687 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
30688 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
30689 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
30690 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
30691 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
30692 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
30697 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
30698 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
30699 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
30700 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
30701 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
30702 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
30703 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30705 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
30706 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
30707 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
30708 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
30709 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
30710 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
30711 argument. For example,
30719 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
30720 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
30721 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
30722 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
30723 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
30725 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
30726 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
30727 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
30728 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
30729 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
30730 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
30731 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
30732 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
30734 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
30735 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
30736 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
30737 whatever the form of its argument. For
30740 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
30741 $sender_host_address
30743 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30744 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
30745 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
30746 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
30747 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
30748 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
30749 for it to change them before running the command.
30753 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
30754 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
30755 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
30756 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
30757 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
30758 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
30759 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
30760 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
30761 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
30762 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
30763 runs for RCPT commands:
30767 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
30771 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
30772 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
30773 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
30774 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
30775 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
30776 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
30777 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
30778 envelope along with the message.
30780 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
30781 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
30782 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
30783 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
30784 can be used to specify it.
30786 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
30787 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
30788 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
30789 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
30790 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
30793 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
30794 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
30795 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
30800 driver = manualroute
30801 transport = smtp_appendfile
30802 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
30806 driver = appendfile
30807 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
30812 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
30813 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
30814 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
30818 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
30819 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
30820 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
30821 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
30822 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
30823 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
30824 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
30825 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
30826 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
30827 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
30829 No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
30830 In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
30832 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
30833 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
30834 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
30835 make some use of automatically, for example:
30837 554 Unexpected end of file
30838 Transaction started in line 10
30839 Error detected in line 14
30841 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
30844 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
30845 The error message was:
30847 501 '>' missing at end of address
30849 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
30850 The error was detected in line 12.
30851 The SMTP command at fault was:
30853 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
30855 1 previous message was successfully processed.
30856 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
30858 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
30859 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
30861 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
30862 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
30866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30867 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30869 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
30870 "Customizing messages"
30871 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
30872 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
30873 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
30874 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
30875 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
30877 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
30878 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
30879 option. Exim also adds the line
30881 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
30883 to all warning and bounce messages,
30886 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
30887 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
30888 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
30889 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
30890 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
30891 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
30892 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
30894 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
30895 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
30896 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
30897 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
30898 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
30901 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
30902 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
30903 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
30904 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
30905 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
30906 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
30907 option, rounded to a whole number.
30909 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
30912 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30913 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
30915 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
30916 failing addresses with their error messages.
30918 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
30919 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
30921 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
30922 as part of the error report.
30924 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
30925 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
30927 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
30930 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
30931 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
30932 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
30934 Subject: Mail delivery failed
30935 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30936 {: returning message to sender}}
30938 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
30940 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30941 {that you sent }{sent by
30945 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
30946 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
30948 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
30950 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
30953 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
30955 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
30958 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
30959 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
30960 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
30961 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
30962 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
30966 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30967 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
30969 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
30970 the delayed addresses.
30972 The third item then ends the message.
30975 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
30976 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
30978 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
30979 $warn_message_delay
30981 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
30983 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
30984 {that you sent }{sent by
30988 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
30989 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
30991 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
30992 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
30993 The date of the message is: $h_date
30995 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
30997 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
30998 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
30999 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
31000 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
31001 the message will be returned to you.
31003 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
31004 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
31005 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
31006 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
31007 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
31008 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
31009 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
31010 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
31016 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31019 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
31020 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
31021 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
31025 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
31026 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
31027 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
31028 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
31029 routing explicitly:
31031 send_to_smart_host:
31032 driver = manualroute
31033 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
31034 transport = remote_smtp
31036 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
31037 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
31038 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
31039 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
31040 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
31045 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
31046 .cindex "mailing lists"
31047 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
31048 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
31049 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
31051 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
31052 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
31053 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
31054 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
31058 domains = lists.example
31059 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31062 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31065 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
31066 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
31067 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
31068 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
31070 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
31071 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
31074 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
31075 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
31076 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
31077 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
31078 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
31080 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
31081 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
31082 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
31083 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
31084 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
31085 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
31086 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
31087 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
31088 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
31092 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
31093 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
31094 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
31095 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
31096 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
31097 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
31098 addresses are not rigorously checked.
31100 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
31101 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
31102 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
31103 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
31104 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
31108 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
31109 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
31110 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
31111 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
31112 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
31113 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
31114 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
31115 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
31116 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
31117 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
31119 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
31120 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
31121 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
31122 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
31123 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
31124 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
31125 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
31126 pre-existing messages.
31128 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
31129 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
31130 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
31131 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
31132 one level of expansion anyway.
31136 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
31137 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
31138 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
31139 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
31140 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
31141 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
31143 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
31144 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
31148 domains = lists.example
31149 local_part_suffix = -request
31150 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
31155 domains = lists.example
31156 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
31157 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
31158 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31161 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31166 domains = lists.example
31168 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
31170 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
31171 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
31172 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
31175 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
31176 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
31177 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
31178 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
31179 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
31180 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
31181 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
31182 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
31183 &"unrouteable address"& error.
31185 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
31186 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
31187 the address, giving a suitable error message.
31192 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
31194 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
31195 .cindex "envelope sender"
31196 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
31197 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
31198 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
31199 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
31200 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
31201 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
31203 .oindex &%errors_to%&
31204 .oindex &%return_path%&
31205 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
31206 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
31207 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
31208 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
31209 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
31210 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
31211 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
31217 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31218 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31220 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
31221 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
31222 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
31223 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
31224 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
31225 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
31226 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
31229 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
31231 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31232 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
31233 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
31234 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
31235 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
31236 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
31238 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
31239 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
31240 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
31241 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
31245 domains = ! +local_domains
31247 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31248 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
31251 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
31252 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
31253 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
31254 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
31257 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
31258 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
31259 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
31260 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
31261 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
31265 domains = ! +local_domains
31266 transport = remote_smtp
31268 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
31269 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31272 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
31273 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
31274 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
31275 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
31278 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
31279 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
31280 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
31281 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
31282 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
31283 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
31291 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
31292 .cindex "virtual domains"
31293 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
31294 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
31298 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
31299 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
31300 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
31302 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
31303 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
31304 have login accounts on that host.
31307 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
31308 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
31309 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
31310 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
31311 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
31312 to a router of this form:
31316 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
31317 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
31320 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
31321 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
31322 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
31323 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
31324 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
31325 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
31327 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
31328 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
31329 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
31330 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
31332 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
31333 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
31334 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
31338 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
31339 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
31340 transport = my_mailboxes
31342 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
31343 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
31344 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
31345 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
31346 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
31350 driver = appendfile
31351 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
31354 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
31355 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
31357 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
31358 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
31359 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
31360 information about the domains.
31364 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
31365 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
31366 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
31367 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
31368 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
31369 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
31370 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
31371 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
31372 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
31373 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
31374 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
31375 example, consider this router:
31380 file = $home/.forward
31381 local_part_suffix = -*
31382 local_part_suffix_optional
31385 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
31386 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
31387 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
31388 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
31390 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
31391 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
31394 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
31395 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
31396 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
31397 control over which suffixes are valid.
31399 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
31400 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
31406 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
31407 local_part_suffix = -*
31408 local_part_suffix_optional
31411 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
31412 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
31413 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
31414 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
31415 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
31419 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
31420 .cindex "vacation processing"
31421 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
31422 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
31423 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
31424 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
31425 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
31428 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
31429 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
31430 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
31431 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
31433 spqr, vacation-spqr
31436 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
31437 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
31438 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
31439 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
31440 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
31444 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
31445 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
31449 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
31450 .cindex "message" "copying every"
31451 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
31452 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
31453 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
31454 each day's messages.
31456 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
31457 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
31458 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
31459 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
31463 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
31464 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
31465 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
31466 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
31467 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
31468 permanently connected.
31470 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
31471 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
31472 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
31475 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
31476 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
31477 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
31478 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
31479 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
31480 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
31481 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
31482 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
31484 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
31485 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
31486 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
31487 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
31488 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
31489 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
31492 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
31493 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
31494 intermittent host. For example:
31496 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
31498 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
31499 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
31500 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
31501 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
31502 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
31503 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
31506 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
31507 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
31508 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
31509 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
31510 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
31511 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
31512 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
31516 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
31517 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
31518 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
31519 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
31520 delivered immediately.
31522 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31523 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
31524 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
31525 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
31526 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
31527 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
31528 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
31529 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
31530 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
31531 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
31532 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
31533 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
31534 single SMTP connection.
31538 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31539 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31541 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
31542 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
31543 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
31544 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
31545 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
31546 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
31547 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
31548 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
31549 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
31550 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
31553 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
31554 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
31555 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
31556 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
31557 email is not desirable.
31559 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
31560 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
31561 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
31562 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
31563 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
31564 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
31565 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
31567 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
31568 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
31569 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
31570 before sending a message to the smart host.
31572 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
31573 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
31574 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
31576 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
31577 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
31578 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
31579 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
31580 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
31581 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
31582 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
31584 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
31588 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
31589 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
31591 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
31592 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
31593 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
31594 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
31595 successful, a zero return code is given.
31597 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
31598 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
31599 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
31600 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
31601 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
31604 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
31605 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
31606 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
31608 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
31609 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
31610 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
31611 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
31612 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
31614 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
31615 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
31616 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
31618 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
31619 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
31620 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
31621 are ever generated.
31623 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
31625 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
31626 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
31627 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
31630 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
31631 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
31632 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
31633 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
31634 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
31635 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
31640 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31641 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31643 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
31644 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
31645 .cindex "log" "types of"
31646 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
31651 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
31652 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
31653 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
31654 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
31655 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
31656 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
31657 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
31658 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
31660 .cindex "reject log"
31661 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
31662 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
31663 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
31664 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
31665 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
31666 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
31667 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
31668 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
31669 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
31672 .cindex "panic log"
31673 .cindex "system log"
31674 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
31675 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
31676 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
31677 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
31678 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
31679 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
31680 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
31681 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
31682 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
31685 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
31686 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
31687 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
31689 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
31692 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
31693 ways of changing this:
31696 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
31701 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
31703 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
31706 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
31710 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
31711 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
31712 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
31713 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
31714 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
31715 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
31720 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
31721 .cindex "log" "destination"
31722 .cindex "log" "to file"
31723 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
31725 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
31726 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
31727 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
31728 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
31729 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
31730 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
31731 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
31733 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
31734 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
31735 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
31736 references to the host name:
31738 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
31740 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
31741 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
31742 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
31743 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
31744 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
31747 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
31748 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
31749 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
31750 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
31751 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
31752 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
31753 implying the use of a default path.
31755 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
31756 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
31757 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
31758 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
31759 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
31760 equivalent to the setting:
31762 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
31764 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
31767 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& if datestamped log file names are in
31768 use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
31770 Here are some examples of possible settings:
31772 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
31773 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
31774 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
31775 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
31777 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
31782 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
31783 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
31784 .cindex "cycling logs"
31785 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
31786 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
31787 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
31788 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
31789 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
31790 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
31791 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
31793 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
31794 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
31795 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
31796 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
31797 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
31798 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
31799 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
31800 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
31801 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
31802 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
31803 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
31808 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
31809 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
31810 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
31811 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
31812 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_&.
31813 Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
31814 &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& at the point where the
31815 datestamp is required. For example:
31817 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
31818 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
31819 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
31821 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
31822 examples of names generated by the above examples:
31824 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
31825 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
31826 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
31828 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
31829 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
31830 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
31831 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
31833 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
31834 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
31835 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& is removed from the string.
31836 In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
31837 character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
31838 removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
31840 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31841 /var/log/exim-panic.log
31842 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31846 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
31847 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
31848 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
31849 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
31850 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
31851 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
31852 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
31853 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
31854 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
31855 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
31856 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
31857 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
31858 the time and host name to each line.
31859 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
31862 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
31864 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
31866 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
31869 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
31870 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
31871 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
31872 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
31874 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
31875 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
31876 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
31877 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
31878 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
31879 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
31880 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
31881 RFC 3164, you should set
31883 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
31885 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
31886 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
31888 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
31889 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
31890 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
31891 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
31892 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
31893 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
31894 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
31895 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
31896 name, and pid as added by syslog:
31898 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
31899 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
31900 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
31901 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
31904 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
31907 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
31908 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
31909 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
31910 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
31912 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
31913 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
31914 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
31915 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
31916 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
31917 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
31919 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
31920 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
31921 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
31924 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
31926 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
31927 without modification.
31929 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
31930 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
31931 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
31936 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
31937 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
31938 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
31939 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
31940 timestamp. The flags are:
31942 &`<=`& message arrival
31943 &`=>`& normal message delivery
31944 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
31945 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
31946 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
31947 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
31951 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
31952 .cindex "log" "reception line"
31953 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
31954 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
31955 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
31957 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
31958 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
31959 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
31961 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
31962 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
31963 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
31967 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
31971 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
31972 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
31973 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
31974 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
31975 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
31976 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
31977 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
31978 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
31979 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
31980 name in parentheses.
31982 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
31983 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
31984 the log containing text like these examples:
31986 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
31987 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
31989 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
31992 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
31993 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
31996 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
31997 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
31998 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
31999 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
32000 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
32001 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
32002 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
32003 suite that was used.
32005 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
32006 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
32007 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
32008 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
32009 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
32010 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
32011 authenticator name.
32013 .cindex "size" "of message"
32014 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
32015 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
32016 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
32017 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
32020 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32021 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32025 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
32026 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
32027 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32028 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
32029 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
32030 to fit it on the page:
32032 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
32033 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
32034 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
32035 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
32036 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
32038 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
32039 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
32040 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
32041 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
32042 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
32044 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
32045 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
32047 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
32049 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
32050 parentheses afterwards.
32052 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32053 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
32054 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
32055 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
32056 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
32057 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
32059 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
32060 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
32062 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32063 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32066 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
32067 .cindex "discarded messages"
32068 .cindex "message" "discarded"
32069 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
32070 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
32071 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
32073 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
32074 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
32076 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
32077 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
32079 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
32080 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
32084 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
32085 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
32087 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
32088 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
32090 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
32091 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
32092 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
32094 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
32095 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
32097 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
32098 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
32099 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
32103 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
32104 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
32105 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
32106 following form is logged:
32108 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
32109 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
32111 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
32112 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
32114 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
32115 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
32116 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
32117 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
32118 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
32120 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
32121 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
32122 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
32123 flagged with &`**`&.
32127 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
32128 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
32129 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
32130 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
32131 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
32135 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
32138 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
32140 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
32141 at the end of its processing.
32146 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
32147 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
32148 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
32149 the following table:
32151 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
32152 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
32153 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32154 &`CV `& certificate verification status
32155 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32156 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
32157 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
32158 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
32159 &`H `& host name and IP address
32160 &`I `& local interface used
32161 &`id `& message id for incoming message
32162 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
32163 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
32164 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
32165 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
32166 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
32167 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
32168 &`S `& size of message
32169 &`ST `& shadow transport name
32170 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
32171 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
32172 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
32173 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
32177 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
32178 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
32179 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
32182 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
32183 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
32184 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
32185 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
32186 during the first delivery attempt.
32188 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
32189 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
32190 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
32192 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
32193 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
32194 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
32195 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
32196 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
32199 .cindex "error" "ignored"
32200 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
32203 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
32204 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
32206 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
32207 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32209 A delivery set up by a router configured with
32210 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
32211 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
32215 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32223 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
32224 .cindex "log" "selectors"
32225 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
32226 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
32227 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
32230 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
32232 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
32233 selection marked by asterisks:
32235 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
32236 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
32237 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
32238 &` arguments `& command line arguments
32239 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
32240 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
32241 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
32242 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
32243 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
32244 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
32245 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
32246 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
32247 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
32248 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
32249 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
32250 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
32251 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
32252 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
32253 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
32254 &` pid `& Exim process id
32255 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
32256 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
32257 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
32258 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
32259 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
32260 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
32261 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
32262 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
32263 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
32264 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
32265 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
32266 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
32267 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
32268 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
32269 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
32270 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
32271 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
32272 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
32273 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
32274 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
32276 &` all `& all of the above
32278 More details on each of these items follows:
32281 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
32282 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
32283 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
32284 this log selector is set.
32286 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
32287 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
32288 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
32289 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
32290 such users cannot access the log).
32292 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
32293 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
32294 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
32295 parentheses between them.
32297 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
32298 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
32299 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
32300 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
32301 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
32302 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
32303 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
32304 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
32305 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
32306 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
32307 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
32308 between the caller and Exim.
32310 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
32311 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
32312 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
32314 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
32315 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
32316 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
32317 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
32318 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
32319 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
32321 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
32322 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
32323 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
32325 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
32326 .cindex "size" "of message"
32327 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
32328 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
32330 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
32331 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
32332 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32333 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
32334 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
32336 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
32337 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
32338 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
32339 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
32340 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
32341 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
32343 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
32344 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
32345 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
32346 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
32347 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
32349 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
32350 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
32351 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
32352 client's ident port times out.
32354 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
32355 .cindex "interface" "logging"
32356 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
32357 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
32358 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
32359 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
32362 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
32363 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
32364 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
32365 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
32366 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
32367 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
32368 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
32369 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
32370 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
32371 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
32372 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
32374 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
32375 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
32376 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
32378 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
32379 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
32380 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
32381 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
32382 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
32383 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
32384 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
32386 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32387 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32388 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
32389 immediately after the time and date.
32391 .cindex "log" "queue run"
32392 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
32393 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
32395 .cindex "log" "queue time"
32396 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
32397 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
32398 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
32399 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
32400 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
32401 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
32402 message has been successfully received.
32404 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
32405 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
32406 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
32407 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
32409 .cindex "log" "recipients"
32410 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
32411 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
32412 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
32413 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
32415 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
32418 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
32419 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
32420 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
32421 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
32423 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
32424 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
32425 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
32426 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
32427 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
32429 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
32430 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
32431 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
32432 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
32435 .cindex "log" "return path"
32436 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
32437 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
32438 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
32439 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
32441 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
32442 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
32443 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
32444 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
32445 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
32447 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
32448 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
32449 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
32450 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
32453 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
32454 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
32457 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
32458 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
32459 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
32460 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
32462 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
32463 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
32465 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
32466 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
32467 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
32468 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
32469 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
32472 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
32473 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
32474 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
32475 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
32476 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
32477 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
32478 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
32479 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
32480 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
32481 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
32483 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
32484 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
32485 reset if the daemon is restarted.
32486 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
32487 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
32488 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
32489 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
32490 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
32492 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
32493 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
32494 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
32495 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
32496 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
32497 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
32499 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
32500 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
32501 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
32502 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
32503 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
32504 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
32505 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
32506 already have their own log lines.
32508 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
32509 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
32510 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
32511 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
32512 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
32513 the same logging options.
32515 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
32516 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
32520 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
32521 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
32522 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
32523 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
32524 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
32526 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
32527 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
32528 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
32529 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
32530 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
32531 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
32532 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
32533 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
32535 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
32536 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
32537 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
32538 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
32539 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
32540 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
32541 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
32542 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
32543 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
32545 .cindex "log" "subject"
32546 .cindex "subject, logging"
32547 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
32548 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
32549 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
32550 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
32551 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
32553 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
32554 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
32555 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
32556 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
32558 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
32559 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
32560 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32561 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
32563 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
32564 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
32565 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32566 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
32567 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
32569 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
32570 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
32571 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
32575 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
32576 .cindex "message" "log file for"
32577 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
32578 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
32579 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
32580 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
32581 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
32582 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
32583 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
32584 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
32585 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
32586 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
32587 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
32589 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
32590 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
32591 &%message_logs%& option false.
32597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32600 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
32601 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
32602 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
32603 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
32604 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
32606 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
32607 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
32608 "list what Exim processes are doing"
32609 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
32610 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
32611 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
32612 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
32614 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
32615 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
32616 "extract statistics from the log"
32617 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
32618 "check address acceptance from given IP"
32619 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
32620 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
32621 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
32622 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
32623 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
32624 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
32627 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
32628 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
32629 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
32634 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
32635 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
32636 .cindex "process, querying"
32638 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
32639 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
32640 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
32641 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
32642 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
32643 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
32644 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
32645 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
32647 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
32648 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
32649 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
32652 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
32653 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
32654 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
32655 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
32656 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
32659 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
32660 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
32661 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
32662 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
32664 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
32666 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
32667 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
32668 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
32669 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
32670 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
32671 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
32673 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
32674 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
32678 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
32679 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
32680 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
32681 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
32685 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
32686 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
32687 options are available:
32690 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
32691 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
32692 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
32696 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
32697 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
32700 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
32701 Match against the size field.
32703 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32704 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
32706 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32707 Match messages that are older than the given time.
32710 Match only frozen messages.
32713 Match only non-frozen messages.
32716 The following options control the format of the output:
32720 Display only the count of matching messages.
32723 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
32727 Display message ids only.
32730 Brief format &-- one line per message.
32733 Display messages in reverse order.
32736 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
32740 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
32741 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
32742 .cindex "queue" "summary"
32743 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
32744 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
32745 running a command such as
32747 exim -bp | exiqsumm
32749 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
32750 it, as in the following example:
32752 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
32754 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
32755 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
32756 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
32757 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
32759 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
32760 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
32761 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
32762 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
32763 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
32764 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
32767 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
32768 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
32769 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
32770 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
32771 level"& addresses).
32776 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
32778 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
32779 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
32780 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
32781 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
32782 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
32783 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
32784 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
32785 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
32786 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
32787 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
32789 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
32791 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
32793 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
32794 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
32795 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
32797 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
32798 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
32799 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
32800 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
32801 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
32803 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
32804 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
32805 regular expression.
32807 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
32808 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
32810 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
32811 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
32812 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
32815 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
32816 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
32817 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
32818 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
32819 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
32820 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
32821 the &%--help%& option.
32824 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
32825 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32826 .cindex "cycling logs"
32827 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32828 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
32829 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
32830 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
32831 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
32832 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
32833 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
32835 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
32836 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
32838 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
32839 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
32840 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
32844 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
32845 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
32846 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
32847 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
32848 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
32849 logs are handled similarly.
32851 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
32852 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
32853 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
32854 any existing log files.
32856 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
32857 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
32858 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
32859 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
32860 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
32862 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
32864 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
32865 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
32869 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
32870 .cindex "statistics"
32871 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
32872 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
32873 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
32874 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
32875 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
32877 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
32878 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
32879 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
32880 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
32881 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
32883 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
32885 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
32886 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
32887 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
32888 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
32889 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
32890 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
32891 also produced per user.
32893 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
32894 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
32895 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
32896 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
32897 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
32899 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
32900 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
32901 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
32902 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
32903 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
32904 an entirely separate message.
32906 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
32907 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
32908 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
32909 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
32910 least one address that failed.
32912 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
32913 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
32914 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
32915 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
32916 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
32917 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
32918 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
32920 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
32921 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
32922 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
32924 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
32925 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
32926 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
32928 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
32931 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
32932 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
32933 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
32934 .cindex "checking access"
32935 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
32936 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
32937 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
32938 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
32939 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
32940 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
32942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
32943 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
32945 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
32947 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
32948 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
32949 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
32950 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
32953 550 Relay not permitted
32955 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
32956 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
32957 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
32958 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
32961 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
32962 -f himself@there.example
32964 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
32965 mandatory arguments.
32967 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
32968 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
32969 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
32973 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
32974 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
32975 .cindex "building DBM files"
32976 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
32977 .cindex "lower casing"
32978 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
32979 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
32980 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
32981 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
32982 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
32983 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
32985 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
32986 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
32987 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
32988 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
32991 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
32992 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
32993 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
32997 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
32998 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
32999 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
33000 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
33002 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
33004 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
33005 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
33007 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
33008 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
33009 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
33010 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
33011 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
33012 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
33014 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
33015 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
33016 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
33017 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
33018 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
33019 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
33020 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
33026 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
33027 .cindex "retry" "times"
33028 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
33029 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
33030 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
33031 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
33032 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
33033 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
33034 output. For example:
33036 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
33037 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
33038 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33039 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33040 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
33041 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
33042 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
33043 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
33044 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
33045 past final cutoff time
33047 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
33048 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
33049 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
33050 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
33051 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
33052 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
33055 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
33056 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
33057 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
33058 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
33059 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
33060 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
33064 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
33065 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
33066 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
33067 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
33068 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
33069 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
33070 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
33073 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
33075 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
33078 &'callout'&: the callout cache
33080 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
33082 &'misc'&: other hints data
33085 The &'misc'& database is used for
33088 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
33090 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
33091 &(smtp)& transport)
33096 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
33097 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
33098 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
33099 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
33100 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
33102 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
33104 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
33106 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
33107 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
33109 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
33110 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
33111 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
33112 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
33113 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
33114 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
33115 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
33116 and a textual description of the error.
33118 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
33119 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
33120 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
33123 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
33124 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
33125 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
33126 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
33127 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
33128 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
33133 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
33134 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
33135 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
33136 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
33137 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
33138 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
33139 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
33140 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
33141 updated sufficiently often.
33143 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
33144 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
33145 the retry database:
33147 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
33149 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
33150 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
33151 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
33152 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
33153 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
33154 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
33155 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
33156 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
33157 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
33158 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
33159 whenever it removes information from the database.
33161 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
33162 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
33163 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
33164 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
33165 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
33167 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
33168 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
33169 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
33170 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
33171 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
33172 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
33173 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
33176 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
33177 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
33182 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
33183 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
33184 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
33185 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
33186 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
33187 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
33188 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
33191 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
33192 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
33193 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
33194 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
33195 by new data, for example:
33199 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
33200 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
33201 used as optional separators.
33206 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
33207 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
33208 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
33209 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
33210 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
33211 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
33212 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
33213 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
33214 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
33215 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
33216 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
33217 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
33218 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
33222 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
33225 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
33228 .vitem &%-interval%&
33229 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
33230 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
33232 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
33233 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
33236 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
33239 Suppress verification output.
33241 .vitem &%-retries%&
33242 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
33243 the lock (default 10).
33245 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
33246 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
33247 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
33248 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
33251 .vitem &%-timeout%&
33252 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
33253 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
33254 default), a non-blocking call is used.
33257 Generate verbose output.
33260 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
33261 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
33262 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
33263 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
33264 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
33265 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
33266 more than 30 minutes old.
33268 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
33269 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
33270 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
33271 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
33272 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
33273 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
33275 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
33276 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
33277 suppresses all output except error messages.
33281 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
33283 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
33285 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
33286 <&'some commands'&>
33289 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
33290 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
33293 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
33294 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
33296 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
33297 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
33301 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33302 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33304 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
33305 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
33306 .cindex "X-windows"
33307 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
33308 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
33309 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
33310 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
33311 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
33312 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
33313 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
33314 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
33318 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
33319 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
33320 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
33321 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
33322 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
33323 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
33324 parameters are for.
33326 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
33327 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
33328 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
33330 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
33332 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
33333 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
33334 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
33335 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
33336 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
33338 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
33339 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
33341 Eximon*background: gray94
33343 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
33344 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
33345 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
33346 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
33347 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
33348 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
33349 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
33352 Eximon*highlight: gray
33355 .cindex "admin user"
33356 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
33357 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
33359 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
33360 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
33361 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
33362 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
33363 different parts of the display.
33368 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
33369 .cindex "stripchart"
33370 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
33371 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33372 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
33373 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
33374 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
33375 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
33376 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
33377 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
33378 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33380 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
33381 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
33382 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
33383 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
33385 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
33386 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
33387 to a single partition.
33389 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
33390 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
33391 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
33392 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
33393 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
33394 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33395 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33400 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
33401 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
33402 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
33403 .cindex "window size"
33404 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
33405 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
33406 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
33407 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
33408 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
33409 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
33411 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
33412 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
33413 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
33414 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
33416 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
33417 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
33418 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
33419 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
33420 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
33421 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33423 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
33424 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
33425 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33429 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
33430 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
33431 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
33432 the main log is maintained.
33433 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
33434 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
33435 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
33436 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
33437 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
33439 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
33440 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
33441 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
33442 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
33443 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
33444 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
33445 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
33446 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
33447 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
33448 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
33449 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33451 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
33452 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
33453 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
33454 It cannot go further back up the log.
33456 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
33457 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
33458 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
33459 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
33460 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
33461 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
33463 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
33464 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
33465 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
33466 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
33467 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
33468 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
33470 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
33471 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
33472 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
33473 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
33474 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
33475 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
33476 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
33477 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
33478 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
33483 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
33484 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
33485 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
33486 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
33487 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
33488 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
33489 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
33490 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
33491 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
33492 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
33494 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
33495 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
33496 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
33497 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
33498 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
33499 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
33500 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
33502 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
33503 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
33504 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
33505 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
33506 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
33507 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
33508 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
33510 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
33511 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
33512 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
33513 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
33515 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
33516 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
33517 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
33518 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
33519 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
33520 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
33521 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
33524 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
33525 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
33527 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
33528 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
33529 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
33530 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
33531 display is updated.
33535 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
33536 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
33537 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
33538 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
33539 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
33542 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
33543 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
33544 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
33545 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
33546 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
33548 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
33550 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
33554 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
33555 in a new text window.
33557 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
33558 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
33559 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
33561 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
33562 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
33563 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
33564 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
33566 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
33567 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
33568 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
33569 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
33570 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
33572 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
33573 that the message be frozen.
33575 .cindex "thawing messages"
33576 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
33577 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
33578 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
33579 that the message be thawed.
33581 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
33582 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
33583 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
33584 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
33586 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
33587 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
33590 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
33591 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33592 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33593 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33594 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
33595 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
33596 which case no action is taken.
33598 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
33599 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33600 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33601 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33602 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
33603 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
33604 case no action is taken.
33606 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
33607 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
33609 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
33610 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
33611 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
33612 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
33613 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
33614 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
33615 the address is qualified with that domain.
33618 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
33619 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
33620 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
33621 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
33622 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
33623 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
33624 if no output is generated.
33626 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
33627 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
33628 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
33629 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
33631 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
33632 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
33633 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
33640 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33641 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33643 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
33644 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
33645 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
33646 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
33648 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
33649 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
33650 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
33651 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
33652 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
33653 its security as compared with other MTAs.
33655 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
33656 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
33657 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
33658 as soon as possible.
33661 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
33662 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
33663 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
33664 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
33665 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
33666 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
33669 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
33670 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
33671 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
33672 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
33673 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
33674 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
33676 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
33677 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
33678 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
33679 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
33681 If ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined, root privilege is retained for &%-C%&
33682 and &%-D%& only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
33683 also use &%-C%& and &%-D%& and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
33684 the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message
33685 reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
33686 that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
33687 privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost.
33688 However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
33689 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is not set by default.
33691 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
33694 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
33695 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
33696 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
33697 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
33698 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
33704 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
33706 .cindex "root privilege"
33707 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
33708 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
33709 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
33710 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
33711 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
33712 is required for two things:
33715 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
33716 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
33719 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
33720 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
33724 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
33725 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
33726 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
33727 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
33728 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
33729 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
33730 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
33731 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
33733 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
33734 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
33735 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
33737 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
33738 uid and gid in the following cases:
33743 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
33744 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
33745 calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
33746 changed to those of the calling process.
33747 However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, only
33748 root callers may use &%-C%& and &%-D%& without losing privilege, and if
33749 DISABLE_D_OPTION is set, the &%-D%& option may not be used at all.
33754 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
33755 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
33758 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
33759 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
33760 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
33761 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
33762 testing address verification
33765 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
33768 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
33769 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
33772 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
33775 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
33776 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
33777 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
33778 will be used during message reception.
33780 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
33781 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
33783 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
33784 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
33785 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
33786 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
33787 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
33788 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
33789 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
33790 generating bounce and warning messages.
33792 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
33793 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
33794 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
33795 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
33797 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
33798 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
33804 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
33805 .cindex "privilege, running without"
33806 .cindex "unprivileged running"
33807 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
33808 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
33809 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
33810 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
33811 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
33812 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
33813 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
33817 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
33818 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
33819 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
33820 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
33822 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
33823 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
33824 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
33825 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
33826 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
33828 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
33829 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
33830 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
33833 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
33834 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
33835 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
33837 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
33838 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
33839 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
33840 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
33841 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
33842 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
33843 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
33844 address this problem at this time.
33846 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
33847 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
33848 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
33849 be used in the most straightforward way.
33851 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
33852 number of restrictions on what you can do:
33855 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
33856 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
33857 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
33858 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
33859 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
33861 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
33862 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
33864 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
33865 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
33866 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
33867 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
33869 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
33870 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
33873 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
33874 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
33875 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
33877 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
33878 owned by the Exim user.
33880 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
33881 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
33882 mailboxes need to be created manually.
33887 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
33888 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
33889 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
33890 gives more security at essentially no cost.
33892 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
33893 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
33898 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
33899 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
33900 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
33904 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
33905 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
33906 .cindex "IP source routing"
33907 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
33908 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
33909 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
33910 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
33914 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
33915 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
33916 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
33921 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
33922 .cindex "trusted users"
33923 .cindex "admin user"
33924 .cindex "privileged user"
33925 .cindex "user" "trusted"
33926 .cindex "user" "admin"
33927 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
33928 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
33929 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
33930 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
33931 permit a remote host to be specified.
33934 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
33935 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
33936 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
33937 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
33938 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
33939 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
33941 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
33942 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
33943 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
33944 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
33945 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
33947 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
33948 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
33949 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
33950 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
33951 includes the contents of files on the spool.
33955 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
33956 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
33957 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
33958 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
33959 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
33960 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
33962 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
33963 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
33964 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
33965 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
33966 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
33967 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
33972 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
33973 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
33974 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
33975 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
33976 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
33977 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
33981 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
33982 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
33983 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
33984 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
33985 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
33990 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
33991 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
33992 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
33993 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
33998 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
33999 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
34000 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
34001 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
34002 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
34006 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
34007 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
34008 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
34009 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
34010 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
34011 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
34012 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
34014 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
34015 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
34020 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
34021 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
34022 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
34023 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
34027 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
34028 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
34029 enough to hold the result.
34030 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
34035 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34036 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34038 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
34039 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
34040 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
34041 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
34042 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
34043 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
34044 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
34045 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
34046 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
34047 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
34048 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
34049 themselves are recoverable.
34051 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
34052 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
34053 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
34056 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
34057 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
34058 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
34059 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
34060 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
34062 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
34063 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
34064 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
34065 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
34066 will always be the case.
34068 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
34070 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
34073 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
34075 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
34076 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
34077 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
34078 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
34079 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
34080 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
34081 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
34082 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
34085 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
34086 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
34087 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
34088 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
34089 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
34090 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
34091 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
34092 normally the Exim user.
34094 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
34095 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
34096 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
34097 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
34098 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
34099 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
34100 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
34101 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
34103 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
34104 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
34105 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
34106 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
34108 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
34109 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
34112 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34113 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
34114 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
34115 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
34116 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
34117 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
34118 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
34119 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
34120 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
34123 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34124 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
34125 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
34126 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34127 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34128 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34130 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34131 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
34132 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
34133 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34134 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34135 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34137 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
34138 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
34139 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
34141 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
34142 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
34143 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
34144 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
34145 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34147 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
34148 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
34149 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
34150 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
34151 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34153 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
34154 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
34155 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
34157 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
34158 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
34159 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
34161 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34162 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
34165 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34166 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
34167 present if the number is greater than zero.
34169 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
34170 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
34171 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
34173 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
34174 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
34175 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
34177 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34178 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
34181 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34182 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
34183 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
34186 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
34187 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
34188 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
34189 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
34191 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
34192 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
34193 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
34195 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34196 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
34197 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
34198 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
34199 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
34200 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
34202 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
34203 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
34204 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
34205 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
34206 supplied by the remote host, if any.
34208 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34209 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
34210 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
34211 generated messages.
34214 The message is from a local sender.
34216 .vitem &%-localerror%&
34217 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
34219 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
34220 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
34221 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
34222 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
34224 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
34225 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
34226 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
34229 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
34230 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
34233 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
34234 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
34235 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34237 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
34238 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
34239 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
34241 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
34242 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
34243 of &$spam_score_int$&.
34245 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
34246 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
34247 certificate was verified by the server.
34249 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
34250 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
34251 name of the cipher suite that was used.
34253 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
34254 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
34255 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
34259 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
34260 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
34261 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
34262 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
34263 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
34264 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
34265 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
34266 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
34267 addresses are complete.
34269 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
34270 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
34271 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
34272 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
34273 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
34274 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
34276 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
34277 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
34278 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34280 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
34281 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
34282 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
34283 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
34287 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34288 darcy@austen.fict.example
34290 alice@wonderland.fict.example
34292 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
34293 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
34294 line is of the following form:
34296 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
34297 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
34299 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
34300 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
34301 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
34302 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
34303 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
34304 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
34305 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
34306 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
34309 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
34310 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
34311 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
34312 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
34313 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
34317 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
34318 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
34319 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
34320 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
34321 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
34322 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
34323 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
34324 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
34325 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
34326 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
34329 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
34330 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
34331 typical set of headers:
34333 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
34334 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34335 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
34336 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
34337 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
34338 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
34339 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
34340 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34341 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
34342 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34343 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34345 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
34346 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
34347 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
34348 .ecindex IIDforspo1
34349 .ecindex IIDforspo2
34350 .ecindex IIDforspo3
34352 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34353 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34356 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail) - RFC4871" "CHID12" &&&
34360 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
34361 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
34363 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
34365 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
34366 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
34368 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
34369 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
34370 different signature context.
34373 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
34374 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
34375 Exim's standard controls.
34377 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
34378 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
34379 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
34380 signature status. Here is an example:
34382 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM: d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
34384 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
34385 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
34386 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
34387 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
34391 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
34392 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
34394 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
34395 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
34397 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
34399 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
34400 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
34402 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
34404 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
34405 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
34406 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
34407 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
34409 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
34411 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
34412 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
34413 The result can either
34415 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
34417 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
34420 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
34421 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
34425 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
34427 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
34428 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
34429 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
34430 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
34432 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
34434 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
34435 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
34436 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
34437 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
34440 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
34442 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
34443 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
34444 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
34448 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
34449 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
34451 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
34452 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
34453 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
34455 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
34456 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
34457 runtime of the ACL.
34459 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
34460 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
34461 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
34462 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
34464 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
34465 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
34466 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
34467 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-
34468 separated list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
34469 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
34472 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
34474 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
34475 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
34476 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
34478 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
34480 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
34481 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
34482 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. Example:
34484 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
34487 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
34488 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
34491 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
34492 available (from most to least important):
34495 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
34496 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be domain or
34497 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
34498 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
34499 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
34500 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
34502 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
34503 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34505 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
34506 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34508 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
34509 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34511 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
34513 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
34514 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
34515 "fail" or "invalid". One of
34517 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
34518 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
34520 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
34521 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
34523 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
34524 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
34525 means that the message body was modified in transit.
34527 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
34528 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
34529 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
34530 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
34532 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
34533 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
34534 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
34535 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34536 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
34537 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
34538 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
34539 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34540 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
34541 The key record selector string
34542 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
34543 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
34544 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
34545 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34546 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
34547 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34548 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
34549 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
34550 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
34551 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
34552 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
34553 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
34554 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
34555 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
34556 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
34557 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
34558 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
34559 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
34560 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
34561 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
34562 integer size comparisons against this value.
34563 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
34564 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
34565 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
34566 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
34567 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomaining%&
34568 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
34569 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
34570 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34572 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
34573 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34575 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
34576 Notes from the key record (tag n=)
34579 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
34582 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
34583 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
34584 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
34585 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
34586 verb to a group of domains or identities, like:
34589 # Warn when message apparently from GMail has no signature at all
34590 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
34591 sender_domains = gmail.com
34592 dkim_signers = gmail.com
34596 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
34597 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
34598 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
34599 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, like:
34602 deny message = Message from Paypal with invalid or missing signature
34603 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
34604 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
34605 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
34608 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
34609 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
34610 for more information of what they mean.
34614 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34617 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
34618 "Adding drivers or lookups"
34619 .cindex "adding drivers"
34620 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
34621 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
34622 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
34623 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
34626 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
34627 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
34629 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
34631 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
34633 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
34634 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
34635 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
34637 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
34639 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
34642 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
34643 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
34645 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
34646 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
34647 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
34649 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
34652 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
34653 as for other drivers and lookups.
34656 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
34657 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
34658 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
34659 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
34660 searched using a binary chop procedure.
34662 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
34663 the interface that is expected.
34668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34669 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34671 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34672 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
34673 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
34674 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
34676 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34681 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
34682 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
34686 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
34687 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
34688 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
34691 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34692 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////